]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blame - gcc/doc/tm.texi.in
trans-types.c (gfc_real16_is_float128): Fix spelling in a comment.
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi.in
CommitLineData
38f8b050 1@c Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1997,1998,1999,2000,2001,
ee3d2ecd 2@c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012
38f8b050
JR
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c This is part of the GCC manual.
5@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7@node Target Macros
8@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
9@cindex machine description macros
10@cindex target description macros
11@cindex macros, target description
12@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
13
14In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
15includes a C header file conventionally given the name
16@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
17The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
18about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
19@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
20@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
21@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
22source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
23containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
24machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
25if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
26through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
27
28@menu
29* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
30* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
31* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
32* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
33* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
34* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
35* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
36* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
37* Old Constraints:: The old way to define machine-specific constraints.
38* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
39* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
40* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
41* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
42* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
43* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
44* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
45* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
46* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
47* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
48* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
49* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
50* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
51* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
52* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
53* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
54* Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
55* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
56* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
57* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
58* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
59* Misc:: Everything else.
60@end menu
61
62@node Target Structure
63@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
64@cindex target hooks
65@cindex target functions
66
67@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
68The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
69which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
70machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
71@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
72used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
73for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
74macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
75@smallexample
76#include "target.h"
77#include "target-def.h"
78
79/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
80
81#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
82#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
83
84struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
85@end smallexample
86@end deftypevar
87
88Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
89form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
90``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
91from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
92@code{targetm} structure.
93
acce4e77
JM
94Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
95specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
96Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
dd5a833e 97initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
acce4e77
JM
98@file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
99themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
100@file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
101
c49a6962
JM
102Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
103are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
104documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
105@file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
106@code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
107@file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
108@code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
109@code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
110default definition is used.
111
38f8b050
JR
112@node Driver
113@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
114@cindex driver
115@cindex controlling the compilation driver
116
117@c prevent bad page break with this line
118You can control the compilation driver.
119
38f8b050
JR
120@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
121A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
122initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
123
124The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
125default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
126choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
127applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
128options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
129using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
130
131This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
132options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
133that the other specs are easier to write.
134
135Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
136@end defmac
137
138@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
139A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
140@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
141for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
142outermost pair of surrounding braces.
143
144The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
145the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
146to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
147@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
148everywhere it occurs.
149
150The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
151default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
152the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
153
154Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
155@end defmac
156
157@defmac CPP_SPEC
158A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
159pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
160give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
161
162Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
163@end defmac
164
165@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
166This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
167than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
168@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
169@end defmac
170
171@defmac CC1_SPEC
172A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
173pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
174front ends.
175It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
176for GCC to pass to front ends.
177
178Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
179@end defmac
180
181@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
182A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
183pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
184give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
185
186Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
187Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
188@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
189CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
190@end defmac
191
192@defmac ASM_SPEC
193A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
194pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
195you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
196See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
197
198Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
199@end defmac
200
201@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
202A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
203run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
204Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
205an example of this.
206
207Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
208@end defmac
209
210@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
211Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
212an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
213read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
214output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
215@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
216
217If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
218standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
219cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
220see @file{mips.h} for instance.
221@end defmac
222
223@defmac LINK_SPEC
224A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
225pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
226give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
227
228Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
229@end defmac
230
231@defmac LIB_SPEC
232Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
233between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
234command given to the linker.
235
236If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
237loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
238@end defmac
239
240@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
241Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
242how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
243linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
244the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
245
246If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
247passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
248@end defmac
249
250@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
251By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
252@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
253instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
254depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
255@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
256targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
257@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
258driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
259line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
260@end defmac
261
262@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
263A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
264mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
265generated that uses --as-needed and the shared libgcc in place of the
266static exception handler library, when linking without any of
267@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
268@end defmac
269
270@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
271If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
272When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
273the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
274@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
275@end defmac
276
277@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
278Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
279difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
280the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
281
282If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
283standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
284@end defmac
285
286@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
287Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
288difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
289the very end of the command given to the linker.
290
291Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
292@end defmac
293
294@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
295GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
296However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
297models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
298@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
299blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
300default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
301@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
302@end defmac
303
304@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
305Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
306configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
307et al, within sysroot+suffix.
308@end defmac
309
310@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
311Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
312GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
313updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
314usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
315@end defmac
316
317@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
318Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
319@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
320@code{CC1_SPEC}.
321
322The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
323containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
324string constant that provides the specification.
325
326Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
327
328@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
329related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
330to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
331these definitions.
332
333For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
334define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
335used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
336used.
337
338The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
339
340@smallexample
341#define EXTRA_SPECS \
342 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
343
344#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
345@end smallexample
346
347The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
348@smallexample
349#undef CPP_SPEC
350#define CPP_SPEC \
351"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
352%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
353%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
354%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
355
356#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
357#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
358@end smallexample
359
360while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
361@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
362
363@smallexample
364#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
365#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
366@end smallexample
367@end defmac
368
369@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
370Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
371@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
372the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
373@end defmac
374
375@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
376The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
377By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
378@end defmac
379
380@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
381A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
382linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
383change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
384define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
385line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
386the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
387@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
388@end defmac
389
c49a6962
JM
390@hook TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
391
38f8b050
JR
392@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
393Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
394string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
395target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
396@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
397
398Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
399the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
400@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
401@xref{Target Fragment}.
402@end defmac
403
404@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
405Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
406a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
407indicates an absolute file name.
408@end defmac
409
410@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
411If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
412@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
413when the compiler is built as a cross
414compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
415to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.in}.
416@end defmac
417
418@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
419Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
420standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
421try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
422@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
423is built as a cross compiler.
424@end defmac
425
426@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
427Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
428standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
429when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
430@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
431is built as a cross compiler.
432@end defmac
433
434@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
435Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
436standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
437default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
438@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
439is built as a cross compiler.
440@end defmac
441
442@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
443If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
444standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
445compiler is built as a cross compiler.
446@end defmac
447
448@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
449If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
450standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
451cross compiler.
452@end defmac
453
454@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
455Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
456variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
457loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
458initialize the necessary environment variables.
459@end defmac
460
461@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
462Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
463standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
464try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
08b2bad2
SB
465comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
466@file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
38f8b050
JR
467
468Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
469replacement.
470@end defmac
471
08b2bad2
SB
472@defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
473The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
38f8b050
JR
474See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
475If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
476@end defmac
477
478@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
479Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
480for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
481usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
08b2bad2
SB
482@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
483@code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
38f8b050
JR
484and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
485and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
486@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
487
488The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
489Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
490string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
491for C++-only directories,
492and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
493wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
494the array with a null element.
495
496The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
497if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
498or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
499operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
500
501For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
502
503@smallexample
504#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
505@{ \
506 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
507 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
508 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
509 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
510 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
511@}
512@end smallexample
513@end defmac
514
515Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
516
517@enumerate
518@item
519Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
520
521@item
522The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
ff2ce160 523is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
38f8b050
JR
524@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
525
526@item
527The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
528
529@item
530The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
ff2ce160 531in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
38f8b050
JR
532
533@item
ff2ce160 534The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
38f8b050
JR
535
536@item
ff2ce160 537The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
38f8b050
JR
538
539@item
ff2ce160 540The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
38f8b050
JR
541compiler.
542@end enumerate
543
544Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
545
546@enumerate
547@item
548Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
549
550@item
551The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
552value based on the installed toolchain location.
553
554@item
555The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
556(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
557
558@item
559The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
ff2ce160 560in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
38f8b050
JR
561
562@item
563The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
564
565@item
ff2ce160 566The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
38f8b050
JR
567compiler.
568
569@item
ff2ce160 570The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
38f8b050
JR
571native compiler, or we have a target system root.
572
573@item
ff2ce160 574The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
38f8b050
JR
575native compiler, or we have a target system root.
576
577@item
578The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
579If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
580the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
581
582@item
583The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
584compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
585@file{/lib/}.
586
587@item
588The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
589compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
590@file{/usr/lib/}.
591@end enumerate
592
593@node Run-time Target
594@section Run-time Target Specification
595@cindex run-time target specification
596@cindex predefined macros
597@cindex target specifications
598
599@c prevent bad page break with this line
600Here are run-time target specifications.
601
602@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
603This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
604built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
605the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
606@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
607calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
608finished command line option processing your code can use those
609results freely.
610
611@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
612command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
613the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
614accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
615
616@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
617object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
618@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
619defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
620with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
621only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
622example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
623and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
624@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
625defines only @code{_ABI64}.
626
627You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
628@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
629or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
630assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
631macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
632to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
633variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
634@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
635preprocessing.
636@end defmac
637
638@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
639Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
640and is used for the target operating system instead.
641@end defmac
642
643@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
644Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
645and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
646macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
647it yourself.
648@end defmac
649
650@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
651This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
652any target-specific headers.
653@end deftypevar
654
655@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
656This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
657Its default setting is 0.
658@end deftypevr
659
660@cindex optional hardware or system features
661@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
662
663@hook TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION
664This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
665target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
666(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
667processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
668definition does nothing but return true.
669
96e45421
JM
670@var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
671@var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
672storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
673option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
674via attributes).
38f8b050
JR
675@end deftypefn
676
677@hook TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION
678This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
679target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
680definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
681option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
682valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
683default definition does nothing but return false.
684
685In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
686options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
687only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
688should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
689@end deftypefn
690
91ebb981
IS
691@hook TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT
692
70f42967
SB
693@hook TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE
694
695@hook TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION
696
91ebb981
IS
697@hook TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P
698
699@hook TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG
26705988 700
38f8b050
JR
701@hook TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE
702This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
703but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
704pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
705attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
706when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
707actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
708@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
709@end deftypefn
710
711@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
c5387660
JM
712This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
713but is only used in the C
38f8b050
JR
714language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
715used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
716frontends.
717@end defmac
718
3020190e 719@hook TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
38f8b050 720Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
3020190e
JM
721various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
722options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
723options are processed once
38f8b050 724just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
3020190e 725of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
2b0d3573 726options passed explicitly.
38f8b050 727
3020190e 728This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
38f8b050
JR
729options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
730@code{optimize} attribute.
3020190e 731@end deftypevr
38f8b050 732
7e4aae92
JM
733@hook TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT
734
128dc8e2
JM
735@hook TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS
736
3bd36029
RS
737@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
738Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
739during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
740the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
741can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
742and @code{nomips16} attributes.
743
744Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
745registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
746operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
747in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
748significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
749for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
750switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
751
752Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
753is 0.
754@end defmac
755
38f8b050
JR
756@node Per-Function Data
757@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
758@cindex per-function data
759@cindex data structures
760
761If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
762provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
763using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
764nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
765when another one comes along.
766
767GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
768contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
769structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
770@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
771to their own specific data.
772
773If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
774@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
775This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
776@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
777
778One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
779RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
780RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
781function, for level 0.
782
783Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
784all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
785function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
786stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
787stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
788@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
789the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
790single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
791longer supported.
792
793@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
794Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
795is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
796The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
797function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
798@end defmac
799
800@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
801If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
802function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
803target to perform any target specific initialization of the
804@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
805used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
806
807@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
808Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
809GC allocation, including the structure itself.
810@end deftypevar
811
812@node Storage Layout
813@section Storage Layout
814@cindex storage layout
815
816Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
817alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
818expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
819@xref{Run-time Target}.
820
821@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
822Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
823byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
824This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
825bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
826be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
827macro need not be a constant.
828
829This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
830bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
831@end defmac
832
833@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
834Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
835word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
836@end defmac
837
838@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
839Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
840most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
c0a6a1ef
BS
841memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
842order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
38f8b050
JR
843macro need not be a constant.
844@end defmac
845
c0a6a1ef
BS
846@defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
847On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
848registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
849the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
850the order of words in memory.
851@end defmac
852
38f8b050
JR
853@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
854Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
855@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
856containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
857have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
858
859You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
860multi-word integers.
861@end defmac
862
863@defmac BITS_PER_UNIT
864Define this macro to be the number of bits in an addressable storage
865unit (byte). If you do not define this macro the default is 8.
866@end defmac
867
868@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
869Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
870is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
871@end defmac
872
873@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
874Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
875@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
876largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
877@end defmac
878
879@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
880Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
881register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
882@end defmac
883
884@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
885Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
886@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
887smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
888@end defmac
889
38f8b050
JR
890@defmac POINTER_SIZE
891Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
892width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
893you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
894a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
895@end defmac
896
897@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
898A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
899@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
900greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
901should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
902is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
903@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
904
905You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
906and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
907@end defmac
908
909@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
910A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
911is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
912stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
913scalar type.
914
915On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
916register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
917@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
918cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
919floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
920counterparts.
921
922For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
923However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
924either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
925the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
926sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
927@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
928
929Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
930@end defmac
931
932@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE
933Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
934function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
935and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
936change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
937pointer} types.
938
939@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
940return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
941@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
942If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
943which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
944then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
945the signedness may be different.
946
5e617be8
AK
947@var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
948
38f8b050
JR
949The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
950also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
951if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
952@end deftypefn
953
954@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
955Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
956bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
957regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
958size of an integer.
959@end defmac
960
961@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
962Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
963stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
964desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
965if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
966this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
967@end defmac
968
969@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
970Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
971stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
972is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
973macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
974@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
975@end defmac
976
977@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
978Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
979from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
980to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
981@end defmac
982
983@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
984Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
985@end defmac
986
987@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
988Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
989bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
990just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
991@end defmac
992
993@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
994Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
995provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
996@end defmac
997
998@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
999Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1000not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1001@end defmac
1002
1003@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1004If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1005object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1006nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1007on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1008@end defmac
1009
1010@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1011Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1012machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1013structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1014by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1015@end defmac
1016
1017@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1018An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1019alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1020@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1021alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1022field alignment has not been set by the
1023@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1024@end defmac
1025
1026@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1027Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1028to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1029
1030If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1031
1032@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1033@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1034@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1035@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1036@end defmac
1037
1038@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1039Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1040Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1041@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1042the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1043
1044On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1045the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1046a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((unsigned HOST_WIDEST_INT) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1047On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1048@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1049@end defmac
1050
1051@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1052If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1053the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1054the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1055macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1056
1057If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1058
1059@findex strcpy
1060One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1061make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1062arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1063constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1064@end defmac
1065
1066@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1067If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1068that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1069@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1070have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1071align the object.
1072
1073If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1074
1075The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1076constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1077constants can be done inline.
1078@end defmac
1079
1080@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1081If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1082the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1083the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1084macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1085
1086If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1087
1088One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1089make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1090
64ad7c99 1091If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1092@end defmac
1093
1094@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1095If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1096@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1097and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1098have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1099align the slot.
1100
1101If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1102@var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1103be used.
1104
1105This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1106of all possible modes which the slot may have.
4a6336ad 1107
64ad7c99 1108If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1109@end defmac
1110
1111@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1112If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1113variable @var{decl}.
1114
1115If this macro is not defined, then
1116@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1117is used.
1118
1119One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1120make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1121
64ad7c99 1122If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
1123@end defmac
1124
1125@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1126If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1127for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1128@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1129
1130If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1131@end defmac
1132
1133@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1134Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1135empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1136
1137If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1138@end defmac
1139
1140@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1141Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1142Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1143
1144If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1145@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1146@end defmac
1147
1148@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1149Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1150if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1151go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1152@end defmac
1153
1154@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1155Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1156alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1157
1158The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1159@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1160structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1161that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1162that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1163
1164Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1165@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1166four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1167not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1168
1169An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1170structure.
1171
1172If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1173a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1174
1175Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1176bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1177support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1178@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1179
1180The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1181@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1182Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1183
1184Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1185@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1186@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1187
1188If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1189bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1190what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1191
1192@smallexample
1193struct foo1
1194@{
1195 char x;
1196 char :0;
1197 char y;
1198@};
1199
1200struct foo2
1201@{
1202 char x;
1203 int :0;
1204 char y;
1205@};
1206
1207main ()
1208@{
1209 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1210 sizeof (struct foo1));
1211 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1212 sizeof (struct foo2));
1213 exit (0);
1214@}
1215@end smallexample
1216
1217If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1218get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1219@end defmac
1220
1221@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1222Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1223to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1224@end defmac
1225
1226@hook TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD
1227When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1228whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1229structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1230the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1231@end deftypefn
1232
1233@hook TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD
1234This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1235should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1236these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1237
1238The default is @code{!TARGET_STRICT_ALIGN}.
1239@end deftypefn
1240
1241@defmac MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (@var{field}, @var{mode})
1242Return 1 if a structure or array containing @var{field} should be accessed using
1243@code{BLKMODE}.
1244
1245If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1246mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1247case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1248retain the field's mode.
1249
1250Normally, this is not needed.
1251@end defmac
1252
1253@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1254Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1255by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1256way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1257@var{specified}.
1258
1259The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1260the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1261@end defmac
1262
1263@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1264An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1265machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1266this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1267appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1268(DImode)} is assumed.
1269@end defmac
1270
1271@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1272If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1273specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1274@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1275@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1276@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1277having its mode specified.
1278
1279You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1280would most commonly define this macro if the
1281@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
128264-bit mode.
1283@end defmac
1284
1285@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1286If defined, an expression of type @code{enum machine_mode} that
1287specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1288@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1289
1290You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1291You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1292pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1293@end defmac
1294
1295@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE
1296This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1297of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1298@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1299targets.
1300@end deftypefn
1301
1302@hook TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE
1303This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1304of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1305@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1306targets.
1307@end deftypefn
1308
1309@hook TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE
1310Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1311The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1312@end deftypefn
1313
1314@defmac ROUND_TOWARDS_ZERO
1315If defined, this macro should be true if the prevailing rounding
1316mode is towards zero.
1317
1318Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1319floating-point arithmetic.
1320
1321Not defining this macro is equivalent to returning zero.
1322@end defmac
1323
1324@defmac LARGEST_EXPONENT_IS_NORMAL (@var{size})
1325This macro should return true if floats with @var{size}
1326bits do not have a NaN or infinity representation, but use the largest
1327exponent for normal numbers instead.
1328
1329Defining this macro only affects the way @file{libgcc.a} emulates
1330floating-point arithmetic.
1331
1332The default definition of this macro returns false for all sizes.
1333@end defmac
1334
1335@hook TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P
1336This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1337@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1338Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1339unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1340different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1341alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1342bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1343the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1344(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1345another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1346other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1347
1348When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1349of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1350bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1351and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1352chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1353size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1354alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1355
1356If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1357the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1358used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1359precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1360may affect its placement.
1361@end deftypefn
1362
1363@hook TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P
1364Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1365@end deftypefn
1366
1367@hook TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P
1368Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1369@end deftypefn
1370
1371@hook TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK
1372This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1373to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1374For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1375for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1376registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1377usage.
1378@end deftypefn
1379
1380@hook TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS
1381This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1382that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1383@end deftypefn
1384
1385@hook TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE
1386If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1387uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1388to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1389mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1390the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1391not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1392for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1393return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1394string constant.
1395
1396Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1397qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1398fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1399is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1400length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1401ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1402@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1403@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1404code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1405@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1406codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1407spaces in your string.
1408
1409This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1410name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1411can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1412before mangling.
1413
1414The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1415appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1416types.
1417@end deftypefn
1418
1419@node Type Layout
1420@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1421
1422These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1423basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1424the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1425languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1426
1427@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1428A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1429target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1430@end defmac
1431
1432@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1433A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1434target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1435(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1436unit.)
1437@end defmac
1438
1439@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1440A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1441target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1442@end defmac
1443
1444@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1445On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1446@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1447that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1448the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1449value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1450@end defmac
1451
1452@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1453A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1454target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1455words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1456macro must be at least 64.
1457@end defmac
1458
1459@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1460A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1461target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1462@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1463@end defmac
1464
1465@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1466A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1467C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1468this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1469@end defmac
1470
1471@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1472A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1473target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1474@end defmac
1475
1476@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1477A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1478target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1479words.
1480@end defmac
1481
1482@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1483A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1484the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1485words.
1486@end defmac
1487
1488@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1489A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1490the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1491@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1492@end defmac
1493
1494@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1495A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1496the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1497@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1498@end defmac
1499
1500@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1501A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1502the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1503@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1504@end defmac
1505
1506@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1507A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1508the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1509@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1510@end defmac
1511
1512@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1513A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1514the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1515@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1516@end defmac
1517
1518@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1519A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1520the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1521@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1522@end defmac
1523
1524@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1525A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1526the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1527@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1528@end defmac
1529
1530@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1531A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1532the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1533@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1534@end defmac
1535
1536@defmac LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1537Define this macro if @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not constant or
1538if you want routines in @file{libgcc2.a} for a size other than
1539@code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}. If you don't define this, the
1540default is @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1541@end defmac
1542
1543@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_DF_MODE
a18bdccd 1544Define this macro if neither @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} nor
38f8b050
JR
1545@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is
1546@code{DFmode} but you want @code{DFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
a18bdccd 1547anyway. If you don't define this and either @code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
38f8b050
JR
1548or @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64 then the default is 1,
1549otherwise it is 0.
1550@end defmac
1551
1552@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_XF_MODE
1553Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1554@code{XFmode} but you want @code{XFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1555anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1556is 80 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1557@end defmac
1558
1559@defmac LIBGCC2_HAS_TF_MODE
1560Define this macro if @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is not
1561@code{TFmode} but you want @code{TFmode} routines in @file{libgcc2.a}
1562anyway. If you don't define this and @code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1563is 128 then the default is 1, otherwise it is 0.
1564@end defmac
1565
cdbf4541
BS
1566@defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1567This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1568hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1569causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1570prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1571uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1572the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1573@end defmac
1574
38f8b050
JR
1575@defmac SF_SIZE
1576@defmacx DF_SIZE
1577@defmacx XF_SIZE
1578@defmacx TF_SIZE
1579Define these macros to be the size in bits of the mantissa of
1580@code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} values,
1581if the defaults in @file{libgcc2.h} are inappropriate. By default,
1582@code{FLT_MANT_DIG} is used for @code{SF_SIZE}, @code{LDBL_MANT_DIG}
1583for @code{XF_SIZE} and @code{TF_SIZE}, and @code{DBL_MANT_DIG} or
1584@code{LDBL_MANT_DIG} for @code{DF_SIZE} according to whether
a18bdccd 1585@code{DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} or
38f8b050
JR
1586@code{LIBGCC2_LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE} is 64.
1587@end defmac
1588
1589@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1590A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1591assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1592default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1593@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1594@end defmac
1595
1596@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1597A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1598supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1599value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1600If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1601is the default.
1602@end defmac
1603
1604@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1605An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1606@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1607always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1608and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1609@end defmac
1610
1611@hook TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS
1612This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1613@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1614of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1615@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1616
1617The default is to return false.
1618@end deftypefn
1619
1620@defmac SIZE_TYPE
1621A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1622for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1623contents of the string.
1624
1625The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1626spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1627appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1628of the data type names defined in the function
176a96de
HPN
1629@code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1630You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1631compiler to crash on startup.
38f8b050
JR
1632
1633If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1634int"}.
1635@end defmac
1636
18dae016
TG
1637@defmac SIZETYPE
1638GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1639@code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1640dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1641the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1642is extracted.
1643
1644The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1645
1646If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1647@end defmac
1648
38f8b050
JR
1649@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1650A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1651for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1652@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1653@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1654
1655If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1656@end defmac
1657
1658@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1659A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1660for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1661the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1662information.
1663
1664If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1665@end defmac
1666
1667@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1668A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1669characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1670@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1671@end defmac
1672
1673@defmac WINT_TYPE
1674A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1675use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1676@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1677contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1678information.
1679
1680If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1681@end defmac
1682
1683@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1684A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1685can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1686The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1687string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1688
1689If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1690@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1691much precision as @code{long long int}.
1692@end defmac
1693
1694@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1695A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1696can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1697type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1698of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1699
1700If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1701@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1702unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1703int}.
1704@end defmac
1705
1706@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1707@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1708@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1709@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1710@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1711@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1712@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1713@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1714@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1715@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1716@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1717@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1718@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1719@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1720@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1721@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1722@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1723@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1724@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1725@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1726@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1727@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1728@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1729@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1730@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1731@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1732@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1733C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1734@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1735@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1736@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1737@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1738@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1739@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1740@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1741@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1742@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1743
1744If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1745type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1746@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1747to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1748these macros are null pointers.
1749@end defmac
1750
1751@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1752The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1753that looks like:
1754
1755@smallexample
1756 struct @{
1757 union @{
1758 void (*fn)();
1759 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1760 @};
1761 ptrdiff_t delta;
1762 @};
1763@end smallexample
1764
1765@noindent
1766The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1767will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1768Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1769always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1770distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1771platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1772that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1773the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1774
1775GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1776this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1777However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1778set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1779bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1780address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1781architecture, you should define this macro to
1782@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1783
1784In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1785in which function addresses are always even, according to
1786@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1787@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1788@end defmac
1789
1790@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1791Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1792macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1793instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1794function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1795data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1796pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1797
1798If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1799of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1800@end defmac
1801
1802@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1803By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1804is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1805the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1806when special alignment is necessary. */
1807@end defmac
1808
1809@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1810There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1811zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1812specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1813of words in each data entry.
1814@end defmac
1815
1816@node Registers
1817@section Register Usage
1818@cindex register usage
1819
1820This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1821has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1822
1823The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1824done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1825on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1826For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1827For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1828
1829@menu
1830* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1831* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1832* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1833* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1834* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1835@end menu
1836
1837@node Register Basics
1838@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1839
1840@c prevent bad page break with this line
1841Registers have various characteristics.
1842
1843@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1844Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1845numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1846pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1847@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1848@end defmac
1849
1850@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1851@cindex fixed register
1852An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1853all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1854general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1855pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1856register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1857machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1858and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1859
1860This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1861commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1862register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1863
1864The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1865the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1866by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1867the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1868@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1869@end defmac
1870
1871@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1872@cindex call-used register
1873@cindex call-clobbered register
1874@cindex call-saved register
1875Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1876clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1877registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1878available for general allocation of values that must live across
1879function calls.
1880
1881If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1882automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1883exit, if the register is used within the function.
1884@end defmac
1885
1886@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1887@cindex call-used register
1888@cindex call-clobbered register
1889@cindex call-saved register
1890Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1891that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1892(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1893This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1894of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1895@end defmac
1896
1897@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1898@cindex call-used register
1899@cindex call-clobbered register
1900@cindex call-saved register
1901A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1902value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1903call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1904macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1905preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1906@end defmac
1907
1908@findex fixed_regs
1909@findex call_used_regs
1910@findex global_regs
1911@findex reg_names
1912@findex reg_class_contents
5efd84c5
NF
1913@hook TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE
1914This hook may conditionally modify five variables
38f8b050
JR
1915@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1916@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1917any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1918of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1919@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1920@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1921called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1922@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1923from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1924@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1925@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1926@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1927command options have been applied.
1928
38f8b050
JR
1929@cindex disabling certain registers
1930@cindex controlling register usage
1931If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1932flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1933@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1934registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also define
1935the macro @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} / @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
1936to return @code{NO_REGS} if it
1937is called with a letter for a class that shouldn't be used.
1938
1939(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1940of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1941controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1942these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
5efd84c5 1943@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
1944
1945@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1946Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1947expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1948corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1949function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1950outbound register.
1951@end defmac
1952
1953@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1954Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1955expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1956corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1957function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1958register.
1959@end defmac
1960
1961@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1962Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1963expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1964register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1965need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1966gotos.
1967@end defmac
1968
1969@defmac PC_REGNUM
1970If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1971register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1972@end defmac
1973
1974@node Allocation Order
1975@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1976@cindex order of register allocation
1977@cindex register allocation order
1978
1979@c prevent bad page break with this line
1980Registers are allocated in order.
1981
1982@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1983If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1984numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1985to use them (from most preferred to least).
1986
1987If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1988(all else being equal).
1989
1990One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1991registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1992instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1993machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1994the highest numbered allocable register first.
1995@end defmac
1996
1997@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1998A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1999hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2000
2001Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2002Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2003register; and so on.
2004
2005The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2006@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2007
2008On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2009@end defmac
2010
2011@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2012Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2013prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2014using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2015allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2016call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, this macro
2017should be defined.
2018@end defmac
2019
2020@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2021In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2022Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2023If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2024based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2025be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2026value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2027to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2028
2029On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2030@end defmac
2031
2032@node Values in Registers
2033@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2034
2035This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2036(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2037consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2038
2039@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2040A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2041at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2042@var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2043cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2044and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2045
2046On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2047definition of this macro is
2048
2049@smallexample
2050#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2051 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2052 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2053@end smallexample
2054@end defmac
2055
2056@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2057A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2058in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2059in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2060multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2061this mode by the number of registers returned by
2062@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2063
2064For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2065registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2066nonzero.
2067
2068This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2069@code{subreg_get_info}
2070would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2071represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2072@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2073registers and so not be representable.
2074@end defmac
2075
2076@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2077For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2078@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2079returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2080including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2081@end defmac
2082
2083@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2084Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2085of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2086should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2087used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2088happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2089floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2090@end defmac
2091
2092@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2093A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2094of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2095registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2096are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2097
2098@smallexample
2099#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2100@end smallexample
2101
2102You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2103because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2104
2105@cindex register pairs
2106On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2107register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2108odd register numbers for such modes.
2109
2110The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2111@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2112register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2113value into the register and back out not alter it.
2114
2115Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2116all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2117@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2118you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2119is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2120and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2121to be tieable.
2122
2123Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2124Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2125in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2126can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2127mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2128registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2129
2130On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2131modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2132registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2133non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2134@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2135floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2136normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2137unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2138register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2139
2140The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2141they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2142instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2143@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2144constraints for those instructions.
2145
2146On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2147so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2148register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2149floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2150be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2151@end defmac
2152
2153@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2154A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2155@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2156
2157One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2158another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2159handler.
2160
2161The default is always nonzero.
2162@end defmac
2163
2164@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2165A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2166@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2167
2168If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2169@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2170any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2171should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2172this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2173accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2174
2175You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2176possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2177allocation.
2178@end defmac
2179
2180@hook TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK
2181This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2182@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2183
2184One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2185is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2186
2187The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2188@end deftypefn
2189
2190@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2191Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2192registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2193@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2194@end defmac
2195
2196@node Leaf Functions
2197@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2198
2199@cindex leaf functions
2200@cindex functions, leaf
2201On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2202more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2203means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2204are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2205normally arrive.
2206
2207The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2208other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2209registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2210function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2211handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2212functions''.
2213
2214GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2215suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2216registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2217accomplish this.
2218
2219@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2220Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2221contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2222function treatment.
2223
2224If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2225registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2226GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2227used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2228in this vector.
2229
2230Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2231the treatment of leaf functions.
2232@end defmac
2233
2234@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2235A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2236should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2237
2238If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2239function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2240will cause the compiler to abort.
2241
2242Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2243treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2244this.
2245@end defmac
2246
2247@findex current_function_is_leaf
2248@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2249@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2250@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2251specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2252which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2253set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2254compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2255@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2256functions which only use leaf registers.
2257@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2258that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2259@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2260@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2261@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2262
2263@node Stack Registers
2264@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2265
2266There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2267``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2268pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2269stack.
2270
2271Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2272they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2273support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2274point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2275stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2276@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2277with it, as well as defining these macros.
2278
2279@defmac STACK_REGS
2280Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2281@end defmac
2282
2283@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2284This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2285the machine has any stack-like registers.
2286@end defmac
2287
2288@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2289The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2290of the stack.
2291@end defmac
2292
2293@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2294The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2295the stack.
2296@end defmac
2297
2298@node Register Classes
2299@section Register Classes
2300@cindex register class definitions
2301@cindex class definitions, register
2302
2303On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2304For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2305certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2306restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2307
2308You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2309which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2310that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2311
2312@findex ALL_REGS
2313@findex NO_REGS
2314In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2315class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2316class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2317union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2318
2319@findex GENERAL_REGS
2320One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2321terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2322@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2323the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2324to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2325
2326Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2327then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2328
2329The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2330constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2331You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2332them in operand constraints.
2333
6049a4c8
HPN
2334You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2335registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2336some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2337cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2338(@pxref{Costs}).
2339
38f8b050
JR
2340You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2341instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2342either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2343certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
b899fd78
JR
2344which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2345or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
dd5a833e 2346class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
38f8b050
JR
2347
2348You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2349classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2350contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2351in their union.
2352
2353When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2354certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2355Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2356a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2357specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2358
2359Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2360instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2361each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2362mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2363single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2364this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2365instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2366single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2367@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2368
2369@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2370An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2371as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2372must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2373@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2374tells how many classes there are.
2375
2376Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2377the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2378in many of the tables described below.
2379@end deftp
2380
2381@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2382The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2383
2384@smallexample
2385#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2386@end smallexample
2387@end defmac
2388
2389@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2390An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2391constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2392@end defmac
2393
2394@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2395An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2396which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2397@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2398register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2399
2400When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2401Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2402several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2403for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2404In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2405registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2406so on.
2407@end defmac
2408
2409@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2410A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2411@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2412which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2413register.
2414@end defmac
2415
2416@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2417A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2418base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2419which is the register value plus a displacement.
2420@end defmac
2421
2422@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2423This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2424the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2425@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2426@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2427@end defmac
2428
2429@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2430A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2431base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2432register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2433addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2434@end defmac
2435
86fc3d06 2436@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
38f8b050 2437A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
86fc3d06
UW
2438base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2439space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2440define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2441the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2442of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
38f8b050
JR
2443@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2444index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2445@end defmac
2446
2447@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2448A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2449index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2450address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2451added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2452@end defmac
2453
2454@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2455A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2456suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
38f8b050
JR
2457@end defmac
2458
2459@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2460A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2461that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2462@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2463reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2464you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2465@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2466addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2467@code{address_operand}.
38f8b050
JR
2468@end defmac
2469
2470@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2471A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2472use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2473memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2474pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2475define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2476than other base register uses.
2477
2478Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2479@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
38f8b050
JR
2480@end defmac
2481
86fc3d06
UW
2482@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2483A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2484suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2485memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2486This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
38f8b050
JR
2487that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2488appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2489immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2490address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2491@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2492corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2493@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2494that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
38f8b050
JR
2495@end defmac
2496
2497@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2498A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2499suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2500either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2501allocated such a hard register.
2502
2503The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2504the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2505two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2506labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2507labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2508may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2509looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2510only if neither labeling works.
38f8b050
JR
2511@end defmac
2512
5f286f4a
YQ
2513@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS
2514
fba42e24
AS
2515@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS
2516A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2517to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2518@var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2519another, smaller class.
2520
2521The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2522
2523Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2524example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2525for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2526@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2527Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2528
2529One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2530@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2531loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2532force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2533immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2534instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2535register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2536@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2537into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
1a627b35 2538@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
fba42e24
AS
2539of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2540
2541If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2542through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2543to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2544reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2545this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2546the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2547@end deftypefn
2548
38f8b050
JR
2549@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2550A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2551to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2552@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2553another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2554safe:
2555
2556@smallexample
2557#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2558@end smallexample
2559
2560Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2561example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2562for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2563@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2564Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2565
2566One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2567@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2568loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2569force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2570immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2571instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2572register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2573@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2574into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
1a627b35
RS
2575@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2576of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
38f8b050
JR
2577
2578If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2579through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2580to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2581reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2582this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2583the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2584@end defmac
2585
abd26bfb
AS
2586@hook TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS
2587Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2588input reloads.
2589
2590The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2591argument.
2592
2593You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2594reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2595@end deftypefn
2596
38f8b050
JR
2597@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2598A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2599to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2600@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2601ordinarily be used.
2602
2603Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2604there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2605
2606The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2607smaller class.
2608
2609Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2610require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2611@end defmac
2612
2613@hook TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD
2614Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2615from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2616@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2617from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2618term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2619directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2620register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2621destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2622source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2623reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2624and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2625intermediate register still holds the required value.
2626
2627Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2628allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2629register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2630address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2631when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2632as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2633that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2634describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2635these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2636of the scratch register(s).
2637
2638In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2639
2640For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2641and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2642@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2643hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2644needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2645
2646If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2647an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2648return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2649If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2650If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2651that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2652
2653If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2654perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2655closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2656required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2657copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2658
2659You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2660in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2661and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2662for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2663single-register-class
2664@c [later: or memory]
2665output constraint.
2666
2667When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2668hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2669register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2670have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2671
2672@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2673@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2674@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2675@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2676@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2677@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2678@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2679@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2680
2681
2682@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2683pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2684Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2685in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2686
2687Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2688currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2689to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2690
2691@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2692copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2693(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2694Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2695of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2696forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2697@end deftypefn
2698
2699@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2700@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2701@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2702These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2703@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2704
2705These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2706target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2707reload phase that it may
2708need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2709register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2710register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2711you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2712largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2713intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2714
2715If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2716intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2717was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2718class required. If the
2719requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2720@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2721macros identically.
2722
2723The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2724Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2725can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2726@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2727macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2728
2729If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2730intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2731@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2732(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2733implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2734@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2735register.
2736
2737These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2738register that
2739contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2740class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2741value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2742register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2743Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2744
2745@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2746pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2747Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2748in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2749
2750These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2751registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2752registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2753would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2754the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2755intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2756general registers.
2757@end defmac
2758
2759@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2760Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2761to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2762those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2763@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2764class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2765and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2766
2767Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2768@end defmac
2769
2770@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2771Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2772allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2773If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2774defined by this macro.
2775
2776Do not define this macro if you do not define
2777@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2778@end defmac
2779
2780@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2781When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2782registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2783hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2784load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2785same as that of @var{mode}.
2786
2787This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2788bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2789in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2790registers.
2791
2792However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2793the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2794differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2795widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2796suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2797details.
2798
2799Do not define this macro if you do not define
2800@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2801is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2802@end defmac
2803
07b8f0a8
AS
2804@hook TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P
2805A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2806to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2807registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2808
2809The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2810has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2811default should be used. Only use this target hook to some other expression
2812if pseudos allocated by @file{local-alloc.c} end up in memory because their
2813hard registers were needed for spill registers. If this target hook returns
2814@code{false} for those classes, those pseudos will only be allocated by
2815@file{global.c}, which knows how to reallocate the pseudo to another
2816register. If there would not be another register available for reallocation,
2817you should not change the implementation of this target hook since
2818the only effect of such implementation would be to slow down register
2819allocation.
2820@end deftypefn
a8c44c52
AS
2821
2822@hook TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS
2823A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2824of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2825
2826This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
1c7836f0 2827the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
a8c44c52
AS
2828@var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2829@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2830values in the class @var{rclass}.
2831
2832This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2833in the reload pass.
2834
2835The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2836in words.
2837@end deftypefn
07b8f0a8 2838
38f8b050
JR
2839@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2840A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2841of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2842
2843This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2844the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2845should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2846@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2847
2848This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2849in the reload pass.
2850@end defmac
2851
2852@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2853If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2854a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2855
2856For the example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2857floating-point registers on the Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2858Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2859does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2860register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2861as below:
2862
2863@smallexample
2864#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2865 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2866 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2867@end smallexample
2868@end defmac
2869
38f8b050
JR
2870@node Old Constraints
2871@section Obsolete Macros for Defining Constraints
2872@cindex defining constraints, obsolete method
2873@cindex constraints, defining, obsolete method
2874
2875Machine-specific constraints can be defined with these macros instead
2876of the machine description constructs described in @ref{Define
2877Constraints}. This mechanism is obsolete. New ports should not use
2878it; old ports should convert to the new mechanism.
2879
2880@defmac CONSTRAINT_LEN (@var{char}, @var{str})
2881For the constraint at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter
2882@var{c}, return the length. This allows you to have register class /
2883constant / extra constraints that are longer than a single letter;
2884you don't need to define this macro if you can do with single-letter
2885constraints only. The definition of this macro should use
2886DEFAULT_CONSTRAINT_LEN for all the characters that you don't want
2887to handle specially.
2888There are some sanity checks in genoutput.c that check the constraint lengths
2889for the md file, so you can also use this macro to help you while you are
2890transitioning from a byzantine single-letter-constraint scheme: when you
2891return a negative length for a constraint you want to re-use, genoutput
2892will complain about every instance where it is used in the md file.
2893@end defmac
2894
2895@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER (@var{char})
2896A C expression which defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2897letters for register classes. If @var{char} is such a letter, the
2898value should be the register class corresponding to it. Otherwise,
2899the value should be @code{NO_REGS}. The register letter @samp{r},
2900corresponding to class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, will not be passed
2901to this macro; you do not need to handle it.
2902@end defmac
2903
2904@defmac REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT (@var{char}, @var{str})
2905Like @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER}, but you also get the constraint string
2906passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between
2907different variants.
2908@end defmac
2909
2910@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2911A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2912letters (@samp{I}, @samp{J}, @samp{K}, @dots{} @samp{P}) that specify
2913particular ranges of integer values. If @var{c} is one of those
2914letters, the expression should check that @var{value}, an integer, is in
2915the appropriate range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is
2916not one of those letters, the value should be 0 regardless of
2917@var{value}.
2918@end defmac
2919
2920@defmac CONST_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2921Like @code{CONST_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2922string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2923between different variants.
2924@end defmac
2925
2926@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P (@var{value}, @var{c})
2927A C expression that defines the machine-dependent operand constraint
2928letters that specify particular ranges of @code{const_double} values
2929(@samp{G} or @samp{H}).
2930
2931If @var{c} is one of those letters, the expression should check that
2932@var{value}, an RTX of code @code{const_double}, is in the appropriate
2933range and return 1 if so, 0 otherwise. If @var{c} is not one of those
2934letters, the value should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2935
2936@code{const_double} is used for all floating-point constants and for
2937@code{DImode} fixed-point constants. A given letter can accept either
2938or both kinds of values. It can use @code{GET_MODE} to distinguish
2939between these kinds.
2940@end defmac
2941
2942@defmac CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_CONSTRAINT_P (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2943Like @code{CONST_DOUBLE_OK_FOR_LETTER_P}, but you also get the constraint
2944string passed in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish
2945between different variants.
2946@end defmac
2947
2948@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT (@var{value}, @var{c})
2949A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2950letters that can be used to segregate specific types of operands, usually
2951memory references, for the target machine. Any letter that is not
2952elsewhere defined and not matched by @code{REG_CLASS_FROM_LETTER} /
2953@code{REG_CLASS_FROM_CONSTRAINT}
2954may be used. Normally this macro will not be defined.
2955
2956If it is required for a particular target machine, it should return 1
2957if @var{value} corresponds to the operand type represented by the
2958constraint letter @var{c}. If @var{c} is not defined as an extra
2959constraint, the value returned should be 0 regardless of @var{value}.
2960
2961For example, on the ROMP, load instructions cannot have their output
2962in r0 if the memory reference contains a symbolic address. Constraint
2963letter @samp{Q} is defined as representing a memory address that does
2964@emph{not} contain a symbolic address. An alternative is specified with
2965a @samp{Q} constraint on the input and @samp{r} on the output. The next
2966alternative specifies @samp{m} on the input and a register class that
2967does not include r0 on the output.
2968@end defmac
2969
2970@defmac EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR (@var{value}, @var{c}, @var{str})
2971Like @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, but you also get the constraint string passed
2972in @var{str}, so that you can use suffixes to distinguish between different
2973variants.
2974@end defmac
2975
2976@defmac EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
2977A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
2978letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT}, that should
2979be treated like memory constraints by the reload pass.
2980
2981It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
2982at the start of @var{str}, the first letter of which is the letter @var{c},
2983comprises a subset of all memory references including
2984all those whose address is simply a base register. This allows the reload
2985pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
2986type of @var{c}, by copying its address into a base register.
2987
2988For example, on the S/390, some instructions do not accept arbitrary
2989memory references, but only those that do not make use of an index
2990register. The constraint letter @samp{Q} is defined via
2991@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} as representing a memory address of this type.
2992If the letter @samp{Q} is marked as @code{EXTRA_MEMORY_CONSTRAINT},
2993a @samp{Q} constraint can handle any memory operand, because the
2994reload pass knows it can be reloaded by copying the memory address
2995into a base register if required. This is analogous to the way
2996an @samp{o} constraint can handle any memory operand.
2997@end defmac
2998
2999@defmac EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT (@var{c}, @var{str})
3000A C expression that defines the optional machine-dependent constraint
3001letters, amongst those accepted by @code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT} /
3002@code{EXTRA_CONSTRAINT_STR}, that should
3003be treated like address constraints by the reload pass.
3004
3005It should return 1 if the operand type represented by the constraint
3006at the start of @var{str}, which starts with the letter @var{c}, comprises
3007a subset of all memory addresses including
3008all those that consist of just a base register. This allows the reload
3009pass to reload an operand, if it does not directly correspond to the operand
3010type of @var{str}, by copying it into a base register.
3011
3012Any constraint marked as @code{EXTRA_ADDRESS_CONSTRAINT} can only
3013be used with the @code{address_operand} predicate. It is treated
3014analogously to the @samp{p} constraint.
3015@end defmac
3016
3017@node Stack and Calling
3018@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
3019@cindex calling conventions
3020
3021@c prevent bad page break with this line
3022This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
3023
3024@menu
3025* Frame Layout::
3026* Exception Handling::
3027* Stack Checking::
3028* Frame Registers::
3029* Elimination::
3030* Stack Arguments::
3031* Register Arguments::
3032* Scalar Return::
3033* Aggregate Return::
3034* Caller Saves::
3035* Function Entry::
3036* Profiling::
3037* Tail Calls::
3038* Stack Smashing Protection::
3039@end menu
3040
3041@node Frame Layout
3042@subsection Basic Stack Layout
3043@cindex stack frame layout
3044@cindex frame layout
3045
3046@c prevent bad page break with this line
3047Here is the basic stack layout.
3048
3049@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3050Define this macro if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3051pointer to a smaller address.
3052
3053When we say, ``define this macro if @dots{}'', it means that the
3054compiler checks this macro only with @code{#ifdef} so the precise
3055definition used does not matter.
3056@end defmac
3057
3058@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3059This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3060on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3061@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3062
3063The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3064and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3065the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3066to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3067space for the next item on the stack.
3068
3069The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3070defined, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3071which is often wrong.
3072@end defmac
3073
3074@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3075Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3076are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3077@end defmac
3078
3079@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3080Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3081addresses on the stack.
3082@end defmac
3083
3084@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
3085Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
3086
3087If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
3088subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3089Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
3090value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
3091@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
3092@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
3093@end defmac
3094
3095@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3096Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3097The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3098
3099On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3100is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3101alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3102stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3103@end defmac
3104
3105@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3106Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3107outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3108zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3109
3110If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3111the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3112@end defmac
3113
3114@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3115Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3116address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3117function.
3118
3119If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3120the first argument's address.
3121@end defmac
3122
3123@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3124Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3125on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3126
3127The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3128length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3129machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3130@end defmac
3131
3132@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3133A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3134stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3135@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3136default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3137elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3138@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3139@end defmac
3140
3141@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3142A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3143frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3144@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3145itself.
3146
3147If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3148of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3149address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3150@end defmac
3151
3152@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3153If defined, a C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3154setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3155on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3156before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3157define this macro.
3158@end defmac
3159
3160@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE
3161This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3162the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3163The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3164machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3165@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3166@end deftypefn
3167
3168@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3169A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3170address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3171of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3172You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3173as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3174@end defmac
3175
3176@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3177A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3178address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3179the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3180frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3181@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is defined.
3182
3183The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3184@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3185determine the return address of other frames.
3186@end defmac
3187
3188@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3189Define this if the return address of a particular stack frame is accessed
3190from the frame pointer of the previous stack frame.
3191@end defmac
3192
3193@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3194A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3195incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3196prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3197value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3198the stack.
3199
3200You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3201debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3202
3203If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3204@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3205@end defmac
3206
3207@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3208A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3209number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3210must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3211be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3212
3213This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3214general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3215frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3216over time.
3217@end defmac
3218
3219@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3220A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3221number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3222only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3223someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3224terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3225@end defmac
3226
3227@hook TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC
3228This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3229contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3230info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3231@smallexample
3232(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3233@end smallexample
3234and
3235@smallexample
3236(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3237@end smallexample
3238to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3239the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3240the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3241@end deftypefn
3242
3243@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3244A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3245from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3246frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3247the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3248previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3249
3250You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3251debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3252@end defmac
3253
3254@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3255A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3256from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3257final value should coincide with that calculated by
3258@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3259during virtual register instantiation.
3260
3261The default value for this macro is
3262@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3263which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3264immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3265some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3266and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3267
3268You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3269want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3270DWARF 2.
3271@end defmac
3272
3273@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3274If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3275in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3276The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3277@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3278
3279Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3280via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3281variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3282defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3283based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3284of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3285should be defined.
3286@end defmac
3287
3288@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3289If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3290in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3291in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3292may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3293@end defmac
3294
3295@node Exception Handling
3296@subsection Exception Handling Support
3297@cindex exception handling
3298
3299@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3300A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3301data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3302@var{N} registers are usable.
3303
3304The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3305handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3306should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3307but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
33082 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3309
3310You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3311handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3312@end defmac
3313
3314@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3315A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3316to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3317This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3318It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3319
3320Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3321untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3322
3323Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3324by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3325this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3326stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3327this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3328that provided by DWARF 2.
3329@end defmac
3330
3331@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3332A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3333to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3334return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3335
3336Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3337return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3338address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3339the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3340frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3341been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3342target call frame.
3343
3344Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3345address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3346the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3347
3348If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3349define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3350@end defmac
3351
3352@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3353If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3354to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3355exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3356using it to return to the exception handler.
3357@end defmac
3358
3359@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3360This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3361handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3362that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3363and so may be read-only.
3364
3365@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3366@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3367The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3368as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3369
3370If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3371represented directly.
3372@end defmac
3373
3374@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3375This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3376to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3377Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3378be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3379
3380This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3381handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3382of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3383to be emitted.
3384@end defmac
3385
38f8b050
JR
3386@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3387This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3388code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3389available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3390through signal frames.
3391
3392This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3393@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3394@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3395@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3396for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3397the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3398save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3399evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3400the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3401
3402For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3403@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3404@end defmac
3405
3406@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3407This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3408call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3409usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3410
0c93ed52
SB
3411This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3412@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
38f8b050
JR
3413@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3414for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3415@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3416be updated in @var{fs}.
3417@end defmac
3418
3419@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3420A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3421info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3422linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3423@end defmac
3424
3425@node Stack Checking
3426@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3427
3428GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3429stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3430three ways:
3431
3432@enumerate
3433@item
3434If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3435will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3436at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3437other special processing.
3438
3439@item
3440If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3441@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3442that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3443static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3444in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3445stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3446approach below.
3447
3448@item
3449If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3450``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3451@end enumerate
3452
3453If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3454GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3455@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3456dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3457
3458@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3459A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3460machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3461is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3462checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3463value of this macro is zero.
3464@end defmac
3465
3466@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3467A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3468in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3469like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3470approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3471@end defmac
3472
3473@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3474An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3475instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3476define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3477the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3478of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3479@end defmac
3480
3481@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3482An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3483when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3484contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3485thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3486is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3487default value of this macro is zero.
3488@end defmac
3489
3490@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3491The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3492languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 75 words
3493with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
34948192 bytes with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for
3495most machines.
3496@end defmac
3497
3498The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3499nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3500in the opposite case.
3501
3502@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3503The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3504instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3505stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3506checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3507default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3508systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3509@end defmac
3510
3511@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3512GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3513represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3514space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3515You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3516use the default of four words.
3517@end defmac
3518
3519@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3520The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3521fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3522@option{-fstack-check}.
3523GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3524normally not need to override that default.
3525@end defmac
3526
3527@need 2000
3528@node Frame Registers
3529@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3530
3531@c prevent bad page break with this line
3532This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3533
3534@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3535The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3536fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3537the hardware determines which register this is.
3538@end defmac
3539
3540@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3541The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3542access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3543hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3544choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3545@end defmac
3546
3547@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3548On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3549offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3550allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3551between these two locations). On those machines, define
3552@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3553be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3554@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3555used for the frame pointer.
3556
3557You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3558is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3559the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3560completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3561definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3562@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3563or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3564
3565Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3566@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3567@end defmac
3568
3569@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3570The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3571the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3572frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3573register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3574wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3575pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3576@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3577(@pxref{Elimination}).
3578@end defmac
3579
e3339d0f
JM
3580@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3581Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3582@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3583the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3584== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3585definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3586@end defmac
3587
3588@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3589Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3590@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3591same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3592ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3593definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3594@end defmac
3595
38f8b050
JR
3596@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3597The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3598access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3599machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3600pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3601to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3602@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3603
3604Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3605address from the stack.
3606@end defmac
3607
3608@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3609@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3610Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3611register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3612function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3613number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3614these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3615not be defined.
3616
3617The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3618
3619If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3620defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3621@end defmac
3622
3623@hook TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN
3624This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3625targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3626nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3627attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3628those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3629
3630The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3631
3632If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3633provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3634Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3635from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3636will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3637@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3638@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3639@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3640The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3641@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3642to refer to those items.
3643@end deftypefn
3644
3645@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3646This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3647saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3648DWARF2 exception handling.
3649
3650Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3651exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3652extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3653in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3654used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3655routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3656registers that are not call-saved.
3657
3658If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3659@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3660@end defmac
3661
3662@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3663
3664This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3665for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3666
3667If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3668@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3669@end defmac
3670
3671@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3672
3673Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3674is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3675Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3676column number to use instead.
3677
3678See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3679@end defmac
3680
3681@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3682
3683Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3684used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3685debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3686should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3687@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3688
3689@end defmac
3690
3691@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3692
3693Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3694that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3695should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3696.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3697return @code{@var{regno}}.
3698
3699@end defmac
3700
cca2207a
L
3701@defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3702
3703Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3704@code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3705target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3706default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3707
3708@end defmac
3709
3710@defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3711
3712Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3713context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3714it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3715defined and 0 otherwise.
3716
3717@end defmac
3718
38f8b050
JR
3719@node Elimination
3720@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3721
3722@c prevent bad page break with this line
3723This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3724
3725@hook TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED
3726This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3727a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3728value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3729
3730This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3731according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3732constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3733to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3734Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3735pointer.
3736
3737In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3738without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3739automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3740@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3741them.
3742
3743In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3744register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3745fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3746
3747Default return value is @code{false}.
3748@end deftypefn
3749
3750@findex get_frame_size
3751@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3752A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3753between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3754the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3755such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3756registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3757
3758If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3759need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3760@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3761case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3762@end defmac
3763
3764@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3765If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3766eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3767defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3768references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3769
3770The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3771of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3772
3773On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3774the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3775must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3776replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3777depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3778
3779In this case, you might specify:
3780@smallexample
3781#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3782@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3783 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3784 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3785@end smallexample
3786
3787Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3788specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3789@end defmac
3790
3791@hook TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE
3792This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3793try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3794@var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3795is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3796preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3797knows about.
3798
3799Default return value is @code{true}.
3800@end deftypefn
3801
3802@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3803This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3804specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3805registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3806defined.
3807@end defmac
3808
3809@node Stack Arguments
3810@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3811@cindex arguments on stack
3812@cindex stack arguments
3813
3814The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3815on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3816control passing certain arguments in registers.
3817
3818@hook TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES
3819This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3820prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3821passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3822cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3823The default is to not promote prototypes.
3824@end deftypefn
3825
3826@defmac PUSH_ARGS
3827A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3828outgoing arguments.
3829If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3830That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3831allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3832it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3833@end defmac
3834
3835@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3836A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3837last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3838defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3839and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3840@end defmac
3841
3842@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3843A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3844stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3845
3846On some machines, the definition
3847
3848@smallexample
3849#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3850@end smallexample
3851
3852@noindent
3853will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3854to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3855alignment. Then the definition should be
3856
3857@smallexample
3858#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3859@end smallexample
4a6336ad 3860
64ad7c99 3861If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
38f8b050
JR
3862@end defmac
3863
3864@findex current_function_outgoing_args_size
3865@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3866A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3867will be computed and placed into the variable
3868@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3869onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3870increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3871
3872Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3873is not proper.
3874@end defmac
3875
3876@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3877Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3878allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3879registers.
3880
3881The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3882arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3883which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3884The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3885of the function.
3886
3887This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3888machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3889which.
3890@end defmac
3891@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3892@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3893
3894@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3895Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3896caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3897when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3898if the function called is a library function.
3899
3900If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3901whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3902@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size}.
3903@end defmac
3904
3905@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3906Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3907stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3908@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3909@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3910
3911Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3912stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3913suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3914stack in its natural location.
3915@end defmac
3916
893d13d5 3917@hook TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS
38f8b050
JR
3918This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3919a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3920and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3921
3922@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3923the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3924@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3925From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3926
3927@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3928describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3929@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3930From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3931arguments (if known).
3932
3933When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3934will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3935you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3936by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3937a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3938in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3939
893d13d5 3940@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
38f8b050
JR
3941stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3942argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3943
3944On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
893d13d5 3945of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
38f8b050
JR
3946calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3947the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3948convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3949arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3950nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3951@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3952number of arguments.
3953@end deftypefn
3954
3955@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3956A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3957pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3958when compiling a function call.
3959
3960@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3961have been accumulated.
3962
3963On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3964that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3965that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3966call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3967appropriate.
3968@end defmac
3969
3970@node Register Arguments
3971@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3972@cindex arguments in registers
3973@cindex registers arguments
3974
3975This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3976types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3977the stack.
3978
b25b9e8f
NF
3979@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG
3980Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3981register and if so, which register.
38f8b050 3982
b25b9e8f 3983The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
38f8b050
JR
3984arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3985the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3986(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
b25b9e8f
NF
3987which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3988nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3989function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3990syntax error has previously occurred.
38f8b050 3991
b25b9e8f
NF
3992The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3993register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3994on the stack.
38f8b050
JR
3995
3996The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3997used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3998@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3999@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
4000describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
4001@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
4002register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
4003register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
4004second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
4005the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
4006As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
4007RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
4008argument is also stored on the stack.
4009
b25b9e8f 4010The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
38f8b050
JR
4011VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4012pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4013
4014@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
b25b9e8f
NF
4015The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
4016machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
4017cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
4018done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
4019@var{named} is @code{false}.
4020
4021@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4022@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
38f8b050
JR
4023You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4024in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4025type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
b25b9e8f 4026is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
38f8b050
JR
4027argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4028defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4029a register.
b25b9e8f 4030@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4031
4032@hook TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK
4033This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4034solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4035definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4036documentation.
4037@end deftypefn
4038
b25b9e8f
NF
4039@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG
4040Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
38f8b050
JR
4041that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
4042necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
4043argument.
4044
b25b9e8f
NF
4045For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4046which the caller passes the value, and
4047@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4048fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4049arrive.
38f8b050 4050
b25b9e8f
NF
4051If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4052@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4053@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4054
4055@hook TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES
4056This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4057argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4058arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4059pushed on the stack.
4060
4061On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4062registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4063first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4064on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4065structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4066in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4067compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4068
b25b9e8f 4069@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
38f8b050 4070register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
b25b9e8f 4071@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
38f8b050
JR
4072@end deftypefn
4073
ec9f85e5 4074@hook TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE
38f8b050
JR
4075This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4076position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4077predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4078passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4079
4080If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4081pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4082The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4083to that type.
4084@end deftypefn
4085
4086@hook TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES
4087The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4088known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4089function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4090by the caller.
4091
4092For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4093determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4094not be generated.
4095
4096The default version of this hook always returns false.
4097@end deftypefn
4098
4099@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
b25b9e8f
NF
4100A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4101of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4102target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4103of bytes of argument so far.
38f8b050
JR
4104
4105There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4106arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4107variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4108arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4109@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4110should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4111@end defmac
4112
4113@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4114If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4115function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4116created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4117reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4118If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4119@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4120@end defmac
4121
4122@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4123A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4124@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4125variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4126is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4127the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4128For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4129declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4130@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4131being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4132arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4133parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4134@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4135
4136When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4137@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4138contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4139an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4140macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4141never both of them at once.
4142@end defmac
4143
4144@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4145Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4146it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4147@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4148is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
41490)} is used instead.
4150@end defmac
4151
4152@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4153Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4154finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4155undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4156
4157The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4158with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4159argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4160@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4161@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4162@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4163@end defmac
4164
b25b9e8f
NF
4165@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE
4166This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4167advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4168@var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4169the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4170argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
38f8b050 4171
b25b9e8f 4172This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
38f8b050
JR
4173on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4174used for arguments without any special help.
b25b9e8f 4175@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
4176
4177@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4178If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4179offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4180which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4181slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4182top.
4183@end defmac
4184
4185@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4186If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4187to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4188@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4189@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4190
123148b5
BS
4191The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4192target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4193always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
38f8b050
JR
4194
4195This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4196For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4197big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4198constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4199@end defmac
4200
4201@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4202If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4203implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4204next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4205controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4206arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4207@end defmac
4208
4209@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4210Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4211memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4212macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4213machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4214@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4215registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4216a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4217required.
4218@end defmac
4219
c2ed6cf8 4220@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY
2b0d3573 4221This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
c2ed6cf8
NF
4222with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4223@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4224@end deftypefn
38f8b050 4225
123148b5
BS
4226@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY
4227
38f8b050
JR
4228@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4229A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4230register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4231@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4232the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4233used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4234stack.
4235@end defmac
4236
4237@hook TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG
4238This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4239as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4240arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4241to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4242AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4243registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4244point register.
4245
4246The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4247false.
4248@end deftypefn
4249
4250@hook TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST
4251This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4252The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4253@end deftypefn
4254
07a5b2bc 4255@hook TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P
38f8b050
JR
4256This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4257to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4258variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
07a5b2bc 4259to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
38f8b050 4260variable.
07a5b2bc 4261The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
38f8b050
JR
4262this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4263internal type.
4264If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4265Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4266macro to iterate through all types.
4267@end deftypefn
4268
4269@hook TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST
4270This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4271@var{fndecl}.
4272The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4273@end deftypefn
4274
4275@hook TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE
4276This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4277type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4278@code{NULL_TREE}.
4279@end deftypefn
4280
4281@hook TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR
4282This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4283@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4284arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4285@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4286@end deftypefn
4287
4288@hook TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE
4289Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4290with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4291hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4292@end deftypefn
4293
7352c013
RG
4294@hook TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO
4295
38f8b050
JR
4296@hook TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4297Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4298insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4299considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4300must work.
4301
4302The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4303required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4304Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4305code in @file{optabs.c}.
4306@end deftypefn
4307
4308@hook TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4309Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4310insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4311must have move patterns for this mode.
4312@end deftypefn
4313
0f6d54f7
RS
4314@hook TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P
4315
38f8b050
JR
4316@hook TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P
4317Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4318small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4319@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4320in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4321In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4322for any mode.
4323
4324On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4325insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4326to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4327if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4328insn.
4329
4330Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4331in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4332the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4333classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4334registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4335registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4336SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4337strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4338machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4339
2b0d3573 4340The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
38f8b050
JR
4341safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4342unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4343that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4344to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4345of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4346@end deftypefn
4347
e692f276
RH
4348@hook TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
4349
38f8b050
JR
4350@node Scalar Return
4351@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4352@cindex return values in registers
4353@cindex values, returned by functions
4354@cindex scalars, returned as values
4355
4356This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4357values---values that can fit in registers.
4358
4359@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE
4360
4361Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4362returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4363representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4364representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4365function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4366compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4367Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4368a function returns a value.
4369
4370On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4371(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4372place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4373@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4374The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
b25b9e8f 4375multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
38f8b050
JR
4376@code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4377location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4378the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4379that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4380port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4381@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4382
4383If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4384the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4385@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4386
4387If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4388node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4389pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4390convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4391known.
4392
4393Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4394which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4395the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4396different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4397
4398@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4399aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4400@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4401@end deftypefn
4402
4403@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4404This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4405a new target instead.
4406@end defmac
4407
4408@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4409A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4410function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4411
4412Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4413support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4414specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4415compiled.
4416@end defmac
4417
4418@hook TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE
4419Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
ff2ce160 4420function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
38f8b050
JR
4421
4422The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
ff2ce160 4423library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
38f8b050
JR
4424representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4425
4426If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4427@end deftypefn
4428
4429@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4430A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4431register in which the values of called function may come back.
4432
4433A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4434second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4435recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4436suffices:
4437
4438@smallexample
4439#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4440@end smallexample
4441
4442If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4443function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4444should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4445
4446This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4447for a new target instead.
4448@end defmac
4449
4450@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P
4451A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4452register in which the values of called function may come back.
4453
4454A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4455second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4456recognized by this target hook.
4457
4458If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4459function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4460should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4461
4462If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4463@end deftypefn
4464
4465@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4466Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4467need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4468saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4469@end defmac
4470
4471@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB
4472This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4473at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4474padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4475is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4476
4477Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4478be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4479or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
44804-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4481@code{SImode} rtx.
4482@end deftypefn
4483
4484@node Aggregate Return
4485@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4486@cindex aggregates as return values
4487@cindex large return values
4488@cindex returning aggregate values
4489@cindex structure value address
4490
4491When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4492cases), the value is not returned according to
4493@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4494caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4495should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4496address}.
4497
4498This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4499memory.
4500
4501@hook TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY
4502This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4503function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4504Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4505will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4506libcalls.
4507
4508Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4509by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4510takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4511possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4512definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4513values, and 0 otherwise.
4514
4515Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4516be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4517to indicate this.
4518@end deftypefn
4519
4520@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4521Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4522in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4523only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4524If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4525and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4526target hook.
4527
4528If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4529@end defmac
4530
4531@hook TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX
4532This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4533address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4534passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4535be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4536hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4537argument.
4538
4539On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4540is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4541caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4542be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4543@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4544the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4545the caller.
4546
4547If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4548stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4549@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4550structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4551to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4552@end deftypefn
4553
4554@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4555Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4556for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4557the address of a static variable containing the value.
4558
4559Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4560pass an address to the subroutine.
4561
4562This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4563nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4564@end defmac
4565
ffa88471
SE
4566@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE
4567
4568@hook TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE
4569
38f8b050
JR
4570@node Caller Saves
4571@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4572
4573If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4574makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4575must live across calls.
4576
4577@defmac CALLER_SAVE_PROFITABLE (@var{refs}, @var{calls})
4578A C expression to determine whether it is worthwhile to consider placing
4579a pseudo-register in a call-clobbered hard register and saving and
4580restoring it around each function call. The expression should be 1 when
4581this is worth doing, and 0 otherwise.
4582
4583If you don't define this macro, a default is used which is good on most
4584machines: @code{4 * @var{calls} < @var{refs}}.
4585@end defmac
4586
4587@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4588A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4589of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4590@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4591returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4592will select the smallest suitable mode.
4593@end defmac
4594
4595@node Function Entry
4596@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4597@cindex function entry and exit
4598@cindex prologue
4599@cindex epilogue
4600
4601This section describes the macros that output function entry
4602(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4603
4604@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE
4605If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4606function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4607initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4608saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4609local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4610stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4611
4612The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4613macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4614
4615@findex regs_ever_live
4616To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4617@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4618@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4619prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4620call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4621@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4622
4623On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4624not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4625they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4626appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4627registers are used in the function.
4628
4629@findex frame_pointer_needed
4630On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4631function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4632pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4633frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4634@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4635time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4636
4637The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4638required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4639listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4640order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4641stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4642the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4643for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4644compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4645or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4646need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4647@end deftypefn
4648
4649@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE
4650If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4651prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4652emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4653emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4654@end deftypefn
4655
4656@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE
4657If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4658epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4659emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4660emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4661@end deftypefn
4662
4663@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE
4664If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4665function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4666registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4667called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4668same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4669registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4670@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4671
4672On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4673of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4674instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4675@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4676
4677Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4678@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4679switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4680define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4681target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4682condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4683
4684On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4685function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4686two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4687is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4688@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4689a function that needs a frame pointer.
4690
4691Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4692@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4693The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4694function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4695
4696On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4697others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4698given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4699number of arguments.
4700
4701@findex current_function_pops_args
4702Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4703functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4704needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4705function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4706@code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4707@end deftypefn
4708
4709@itemize @bullet
4710@item
4711@findex current_function_pretend_args_size
4712A region of @code{current_function_pretend_args_size} bytes of
4713uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4714stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4715if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4716arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4717yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4718region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4719registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4720features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4721
4722@item
4723An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4724The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4725the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4726machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4727in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4728a save area.
4729
4730@item
4731A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4732boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4733this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4734save area closer to the top of the stack.
4735
4736@item
4737@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4738Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4739@code{current_function_outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4740argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4741@end itemize
4742
4743@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4744Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4745instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4746pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4747adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4748default is 0.
4749
4750Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4751frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4752stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4753compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4754@end defmac
4755
4756@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4757Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4758used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4759pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4760@end defmac
4761
4762@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4763Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4764used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4765on entry to an exception edge.
4766@end defmac
4767
4768@defmac DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE
4769Define this macro if the function epilogue contains delay slots to which
4770instructions from the rest of the function can be ``moved''. The
4771definition should be a C expression whose value is an integer
4772representing the number of delay slots there.
4773@end defmac
4774
4775@defmac ELIGIBLE_FOR_EPILOGUE_DELAY (@var{insn}, @var{n})
4776A C expression that returns 1 if @var{insn} can be placed in delay
4777slot number @var{n} of the epilogue.
4778
4779The argument @var{n} is an integer which identifies the delay slot now
4780being considered (since different slots may have different rules of
4781eligibility). It is never negative and is always less than the number
4782of epilogue delay slots (what @code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE} returns).
4783If you reject a particular insn for a given delay slot, in principle, it
4784may be reconsidered for a subsequent delay slot. Also, other insns may
4785(at least in principle) be considered for the so far unfilled delay
4786slot.
4787
4788@findex current_function_epilogue_delay_list
4789@findex final_scan_insn
4790The insns accepted to fill the epilogue delay slots are put in an RTL
4791list made with @code{insn_list} objects, stored in the variable
4792@code{current_function_epilogue_delay_list}. The insn for the first
4793delay slot comes first in the list. Your definition of the macro
4794@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} should fill the delay slots by
4795outputting the insns in this list, usually by calling
4796@code{final_scan_insn}.
4797
4798You need not define this macro if you did not define
4799@code{DELAY_SLOTS_FOR_EPILOGUE}.
4800@end defmac
4801
4802@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4803A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4804function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4805inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4806adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4807the real function.
4808
4809First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4810contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4811contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4812in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4813e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4814all other incoming arguments.
4815
4816Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4817made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4818adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4819
4820@smallexample
4821p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4822@end smallexample
4823
4824After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4825@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4826not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4827return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4828
4829The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4830the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4831of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4832and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4833
4834The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4835have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4836some targets, but probably not.
4837
4838If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4839front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4840@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4841not support varargs.
4842@end deftypefn
4843
4844@hook TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK
4845A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4846to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4847arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4848generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4849previously exposed.
4850@end deftypefn
4851
4852@node Profiling
4853@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4854@cindex profiling, code generation
4855
4856These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4857
4858@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4859A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4860assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4861
4862@findex mcount
4863The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4864your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4865compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4866compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4867
4868Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4869variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4870@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4871the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4872@end defmac
4873
4874@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4875A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4876code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4877not support profiling.
4878@end defmac
4879
4880@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4881Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4882@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4883allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4884implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4885@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4886@end defmac
4887
4888@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4889Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4890the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4891@end defmac
4892
4893@node Tail Calls
4894@subsection Permitting tail calls
4895@cindex tail calls
4896
4897@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL
4898True if it is ok to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4899call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4900or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4901
4902It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4903tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4904during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4905as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4906``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4907may vary greatly between different architectures.
4908@end deftypefn
4909
4910@hook TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY
4911Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4912function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4913cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4914registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4915TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4916FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4917@end deftypefn
4918
ee3d2ecd
JJ
4919@hook TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE
4920
38f8b050
JR
4921@node Stack Smashing Protection
4922@subsection Stack smashing protection
4923@cindex stack smashing protection
4924
4925@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD
4926This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4927for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4928runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4929that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4930variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4931
4932The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4933@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4934@end deftypefn
4935
4936@hook TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL
b3c144a3 4937This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
38f8b050
JR
4938stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4939involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4940
4941The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4942@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4943normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4944@end deftypefn
4945
7458026b
ILT
4946@hook TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK
4947
38f8b050
JR
4948@node Varargs
4949@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4950@cindex varargs implementation
4951
4952GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4953@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4954on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4955varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4956conditionals to include it.
4957
4958ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4959the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4960implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4961to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4962@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4963supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4964
4965However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4966the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4967below.
4968
4969@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4970Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4971that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4972versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4973you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4974
4975On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4976control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4977other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4978found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4979
4980Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4981beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4982@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4983This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4984to use them for its own purposes.
4985@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4986@c 10feb93
4987@end defmac
4988
38f8b050 4989@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
c59a0a1d 4990This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
38f8b050
JR
4991argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4992returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4993argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4994fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4995verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4996of the current function.
4997@end defmac
4998
4999@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5000Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5001passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5002has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5003specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5004with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5005
5006@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5007considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5008kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5009
5010The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5011interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5012@end defmac
5013
5014These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5015
5016@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS
5017If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5018@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5019beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5020return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5021to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5022@end deftypefn
5023
5024@hook TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS
5025This target hook offers an alternative to using
5026@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5027@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5028register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5029have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5030use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5031pass all their arguments on the stack.
5032
5033The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5034structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5035named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5036last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5037
5038The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5039argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5040store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5041variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5042store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5043frame.
5044
5045Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5046compile time without knowing their data types,
5047@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5048have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5049for all data types.
5050
5051If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5052arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5053happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5054end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5055not generate any instructions in this case.
5056@end deftypefn
5057
5058@hook TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING
5059Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5060argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5061
b25b9e8f 5062This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
38f8b050
JR
5063is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5064@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5065arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5066but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5067then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5068except the last are treated as named.
5069
5070You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5071@end deftypefn
5072
5073@hook TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED
5074If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5075@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5076@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5077defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5078@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5079Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5080@end deftypefn
5081
5082@node Trampolines
5083@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5084@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5085@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5086
5087A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5088when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5089the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5090tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5091trampoline.
5092
5093The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5094address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5095the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5096two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5097exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5098machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5099two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5100operands.
5101
5102The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5103parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5104immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5105simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5106proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5107may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5108separately.
5109
5110@hook TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE
5111This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5112on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5113the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5114label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5115
5116If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5117for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5118code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5119to generate it on the spot.
5120@end deftypefn
5121
5122@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5123Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5124(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5125@end defmac
5126
5127@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5128A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5129@end defmac
5130
5131@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5132Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5133
5134If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5135is used for aligning trampolines.
5136@end defmac
5137
5138@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT
5139This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5140@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5141is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5142RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5143when it is called.
5144
5145If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5146first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5147from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
ff2ce160 5148Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
38f8b050
JR
5149trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5150to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5151
5152If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
ff2ce160 5153enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
38f8b050
JR
5154initializing the trampoline proper.
5155@end deftypefn
5156
5157@hook TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS
5158This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5159the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5160memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5161the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5162address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5163be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5164If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5165@end deftypefn
5166
5167Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5168separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5169fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5170jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5171
5172Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5173the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5174make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5175subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5176latter makes initialization faster.
5177
5178To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5179the following macro.
5180
5181@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5182If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5183cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5184typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5185@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5186@end defmac
5187
38f8b050
JR
5188To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5189you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5190cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5191beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5192its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5193
5194@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5195Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5196work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5197which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5198@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5199
5200If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5201C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5202special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5203statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5204global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5205special assembler code.
5206@end defmac
5207
5208@node Library Calls
5209@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5210@cindex library subroutine names
5211@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5212
5213@c prevent bad page break with this line
5214Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5215
5216@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5217This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5218expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5219provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5220are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5221@end defmac
5222
5223@findex set_optab_libfunc
5224@findex init_one_libfunc
5225@hook TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS
5226This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5227existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5228@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5229@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5230library routines.
5231
5232The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5233@end deftypefn
5234
cdbf4541
BS
5235@hook TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5236
38f8b050
JR
5237@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5238This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5239implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5240mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5241return a tristate.
5242
5243GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5244comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5245don't need to define this macro.
5246@end defmac
5247
5248@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5249This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5250functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5251operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5252and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5253If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5254@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5255in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5256@end defmac
5257
38f8b050
JR
5258@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5259@findex matherr
5260@defmac TARGET_EDOM
5261The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5262expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5263deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5264@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5265system.
5266
5267If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5268domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5269error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5270there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5271that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5272@end defmac
5273
5274@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5275@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5276Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5277refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5278@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5279macro, a reasonable default is used.
5280@end defmac
5281
5282@cindex C99 math functions, implicit usage
5283@defmac TARGET_C99_FUNCTIONS
5284When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize @code{sin} calls into
5285@code{sinf} and similarly for other functions defined by C99 standard. The
5286default is zero because a number of existing systems lack support for these
5287functions in their runtime so this macro needs to be redefined to one on
5288systems that do support the C99 runtime.
5289@end defmac
5290
5291@cindex sincos math function, implicit usage
5292@defmac TARGET_HAS_SINCOS
5293When this macro is nonzero, GCC will implicitly optimize calls to @code{sin}
5294and @code{cos} with the same argument to a call to @code{sincos}. The
5295default is zero. The target has to provide the following functions:
5296@smallexample
5297void sincos(double x, double *sin, double *cos);
5298void sincosf(float x, float *sin, float *cos);
5299void sincosl(long double x, long double *sin, long double *cos);
5300@end smallexample
5301@end defmac
5302
5303@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
fea3ca91
IS
5304Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5305by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5306and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5307This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5308the NeXT runtime installed.
5309
5310If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5311will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5312selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5313
5314In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5315scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
38f8b050
JR
5316@end defmac
5317
5318@node Addressing Modes
5319@section Addressing Modes
5320@cindex addressing modes
5321
5322@c prevent bad page break with this line
5323This is about addressing modes.
5324
5325@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5326@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5327@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5328@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5329A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5330pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5331@end defmac
5332
5333@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5334@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5335A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5336post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5337the size of the memory operand.
5338@end defmac
5339
5340@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5341@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5342A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5343post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5344@end defmac
5345
5346@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5347A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5348is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5349@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5350is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
ff2ce160 5351constant addresses are supported.
38f8b050
JR
5352@end defmac
5353
5354@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5355@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5356accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5357known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5358expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5359@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5360@end defmac
5361
5362@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5363A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5364memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5365the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5366accept.
5367@end defmac
5368
5369@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
5370A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5371address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5372
5373Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5374non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5375desired by the caller.
5376
5377The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5378that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5379considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5380kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5381must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5382up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5383register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5384if the array holds @code{-1}.
5385
5386The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5387accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5388register is required.
5389
5390Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5391and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5392constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5393specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5394recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5395
5396Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5397sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5398@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5399naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5400be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5401
5402@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5403On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5404the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5405target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5406into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5407@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5408@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5409Format}.
5410
5411@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5412Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5413this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5414has this syntax:
5415
5416@example
5417#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5418@end example
5419
5420@noindent
5421and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5422address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
6f7b223b
PK
5423
5424@findex REG_OK_STRICT
5425Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5426macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5427@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5428that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5429
38f8b050
JR
5430Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5431files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5432@end deftypefn
5433
5434@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5435A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5436character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5437letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5438@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5439support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5440semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5441preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5442@code{'m'} constraint.
5443@end defmac
5444
5445@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5446A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5447or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5448can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5449@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5450
5451It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5452that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5453
5454The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5455a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5456@end defmac
5457
5458@hook TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5459This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5460operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5461address.
5462
5463@findex break_out_memory_refs
5464@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5465and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5466@var{x}.
5467
5468The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5469@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5470should return the new @var{x}.
5471
f938987f
HPN
5472It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5473with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5474The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5475the target supports only emulated TLS, it
38f8b050
JR
5476is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5477a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5478strategy can generate better code.
5479@end deftypefn
5480
5481@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5482A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5483that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5484@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5485It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5486performance reasons.
5487
5488For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5489reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5490registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5491processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5492needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5493@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5494generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5495be shared.
5496
5497@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5498to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5499and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5500of reload internals.
5501
5502@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5503previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5504then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5505
5506@findex push_reload
5507The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5508need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5509suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5510
5511The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5512@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5513should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5514This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5515@code{push_reload}.
5516
5517@findex strict_memory_address_p
5518The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5519the address has become legitimate.
5520
5521@findex copy_rtx
5522If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5523this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5524single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5525top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5526It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5527address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5528@end defmac
5529
5530@hook TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P
5531This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} can have
5532different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5533reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5534but not others.
5535
5536Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5537effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5538of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5539addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5540
5541You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5542
5543The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5544@end deftypefn
5545
5546@defmac GO_IF_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS (@var{addr}, @var{label})
5547A C statement or compound statement with a conditional @code{goto
5548@var{label};} executed if memory address @var{x} (an RTX) can have
5549different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5550reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5551but not others.
5552
5553Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5554effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5555of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5556addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5557
5558You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5559
5560These are obsolete macros, replaced by the
5561@code{TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P} target hook.
5562@end defmac
5563
1a627b35
RS
5564@hook TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P
5565This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5566@var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5567@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5568
5569The default definition returns true.
5570@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
5571
5572@hook TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
5573This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5574@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5575macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5576references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5577addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5578the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5579into their original form.
5580@end deftypefn
5581
93bcc8c9
JJ
5582@hook TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P
5583This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5584debug sections.
5585@end deftypefn
5586
38f8b050
JR
5587@hook TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM
5588This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
fbbf66e7
RS
5589should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5590of @var{x}.
5591
5592The default version of this hook returns false.
38f8b050
JR
5593
5594The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5595deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5596from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5597holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5598of TLS symbols for various targets.
5599@end deftypefn
5600
5601@hook TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P
5602This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5603be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5604of @var{x}.
5605
5606The default version returns false for all constants.
5607@end deftypefn
5608
89356d17 5609@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL
38f8b050
JR
5610This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
5611the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5612@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
5613when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5614@var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5615of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5616function are valid.
5617@end deftypefn
5618
5619@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD
5620This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5621address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5622used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5623@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5624
5625The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5626@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5627the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5628@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5629two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5630@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5631the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5632from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5633@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5634@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5635@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5636
5637If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5638to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5639use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5640@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5641should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5642described above.
5643If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5644the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5645log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5646@end deftypefn
5647
38f8b050
JR
5648@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST
5649Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
ff2ce160 5650For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
720f5239 5651misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
38f8b050
JR
5652@end deftypefn
5653
5654@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE
5655Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5656@end deftypefn
5657
5a3c0068 5658@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK
5dea5b2a 5659Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
38f8b050
JR
5660@end deftypefn
5661
5662@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION
5663This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5664input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5665The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5666specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5667(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5668
5669If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5670@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5671conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5672@end deftypefn
5673
5674@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION
5675This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5676vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5677@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5678The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5679return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5680@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5681@end deftypefn
5682
5683@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT
5684This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5685store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5686parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5687the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5688parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5689@end deftypefn
5690
cc4b5170
RG
5691@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE
5692This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5693mode @var{mode}. The default is
5694equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
26983c22
L
5695transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5696@end deftypefn
5697
767f865f
RG
5698@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES
5699This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5700after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5701mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5702The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5703@end deftypefn
5704
c3e7ee41
BS
5705@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST
5706
5707@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST
5708
5709@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST
5710
5711@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA
5712
0a35513e
AH
5713@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_LOAD
5714
5715@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_STORE
5716
aec7ae7d
JJ
5717@hook TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER
5718Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
5719is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5720the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5721The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5722loads.
5723@end deftypefn
5724
38f8b050
JR
5725@node Anchored Addresses
5726@section Anchored Addresses
5727@cindex anchored addresses
5728@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5729
5730GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5731For example, if we have:
5732
5733@smallexample
5734static int a, b, c;
5735int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5736@end smallexample
5737
5738the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5739addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5740it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5741the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5742be something like:
5743
5744@smallexample
5745int foo (void)
5746@{
5747 register int *xr = &x;
5748 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5749@}
5750@end smallexample
5751
5752(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5753``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5754
5755The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5756in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5757section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5758or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5759
5760@hook TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5761The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5762On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5763applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5764for every mode. The default value is 0.
5765@end deftypevr
5766
5767@hook TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5768Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5769offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5770value is 0.
5771@end deftypevr
5772
5773@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR
5774Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5775@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5776The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5777of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5778
5779If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5780it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5781If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5782is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5783@end deftypefn
5784
5785@hook TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P
5786Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5787@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5788@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5789
5790The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5791intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5792or target-specific sections.
5793@end deftypefn
5794
5795@node Condition Code
5796@section Condition Code Status
5797@cindex condition code status
5798
5799The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5800two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5801
5802The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5803(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5804clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5805register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5806architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5807most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5808most RISC machines.
5809
5810The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5811the definition and use of the condition code, which need to be in adjacent
5812insns for machines using @code{(cc0)}. This can prevent important
5813optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5814is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5815three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5816scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5817separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5818
5819For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5820represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5821condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5822condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5823or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5824Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5825that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5826
5827Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5828specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5829interested in most macros in this section.
5830
5831@menu
5832* CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5833* MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
ac7eb5c6 5834* Cond Exec Macros:: Macros to control conditional execution.
38f8b050
JR
5835@end menu
5836
5837@node CC0 Condition Codes
5838@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5839@findex cc0
5840
5841@findex cc_status
5842The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5843describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5844the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5845variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5846currently based, and several standard flags.
5847
5848Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5849description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5850information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5851
5852@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5853C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5854component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5855
5856This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5857@end defmac
5858
5859@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5860A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5861The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5862the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5863define this macro to initialize it.
5864
5865This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5866@end defmac
5867
5868@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5869A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5870appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5871this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5872code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5873set @code{(cc0)}.
5874
5875This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5876
5877If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5878other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5879invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5880reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5881registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5882@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5883insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5884based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5885value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5886this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5887@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5888@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5889condition code value.
5890
5891The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5892with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5893@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5894constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5895insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5896@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5897@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5898
5899A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5900that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5901@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5902two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5903@end defmac
5904
5905@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5906@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5907@findex CCmode
5908@findex MODE_CC
5909
5910@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5911On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5912than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5913code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5914when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5915bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5916branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5917this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
5918record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
5919also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
5920unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
5921
5922If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
5923@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
5924a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
5925have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
5926by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
5927be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
5928the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
5929
5930@smallexample
5931(define_insn ""
5932 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
5933 (compare:CC_NOOV
5934 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
5935 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
5936 (const_int 0)))]
5937 ""
5938 "@dots{}")
5939@end smallexample
5940
5941@noindent
5942together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
5943for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
5944
5945@smallexample
5946#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
5947 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
5948 ? ((OP == EQ || OP == NE) ? CCFPmode : CCFPEmode) \
5949 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
5950 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG) \
5951 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
5952@end smallexample
5953
5954Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
5955were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
5956this section.
5957
5958You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
5959in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
5960@end defmac
5961
5962@defmac CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (@var{code}, @var{op0}, @var{op1})
5963On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
5964convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
5965does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
5966comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
5967
5968On such machines, define this macro to be a C statement to do any
5969required conversions. @var{code} is the initial comparison code
5970and @var{op0} and @var{op1} are the left and right operands of the
5971comparison, respectively. You should modify @var{code}, @var{op0}, and
5972@var{op1} as required.
5973
5974GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
5975valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
5976@file{md} file.
5977
5978You need not define this macro if it would never change the comparison
5979code or operands.
5980@end defmac
5981
5982@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
5983A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
5984comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
5985can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
5986then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
5987
5988You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
5989floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
5990For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
5991inequality comparisons are always given @code{CCFPEmode}:
5992
5993@smallexample
5994#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) ((MODE) != CCFPEmode)
5995@end smallexample
5996@end defmac
5997
5998@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
5999A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6000comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6001@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6002machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6003instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6004freely convert unordered compares to ordered one. Then definition may look
6005like:
6006
6007@smallexample
6008#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6009 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6010 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6011@end smallexample
6012@end defmac
6013
6014@hook TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS
6015On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6016register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6017regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6018hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6019small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6020to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6021arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6022When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6023integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6024@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6025
6026The default version of this hook returns false.
6027@end deftypefn
6028
6029@hook TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE
6030On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6031@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6032validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6033target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6034both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6035return @code{VOIDmode}.
6036
6037The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6038same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6039returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6040@end deftypefn
6041
ac7eb5c6 6042@node Cond Exec Macros
38f8b050
JR
6043@subsection Macros to control conditional execution
6044@findex conditional execution
6045@findex predication
6046
6047There is one macro that may need to be defined for targets
6048supporting conditional execution, independent of how they
6049represent conditional branches.
6050
38f8b050
JR
6051@node Costs
6052@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6053@cindex costs of instructions
6054@cindex relative costs
6055@cindex speed of instructions
6056
6057These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6058on the target machine.
6059
6060@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6061A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6062register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6063expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6064value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6065that.
6066
6067It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6068same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6069registers if they are not general registers.
6070
6071If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6072hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6073classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6074constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6075allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6076if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6077
6078These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6079@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6080@end defmac
6081
6082@hook TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST
6083This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6084from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6085are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6086A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6087that.
6088
6089It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6090same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6091registers if they are not general registers.
6092
6093If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6094hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6095classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6096constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6097allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6098if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6099
6100The default version of this function returns 2.
6101@end deftypefn
6102
6103@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6104A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6105register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6106is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6107is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6108registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6109should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6110
6111If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6112the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6113needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6114between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6115more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6116reflect the actual cost of the move.
6117
6118GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6119secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6120a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6121secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61224 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6123value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6124are the same as to this macro.
6125
6126These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6127@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6128@end defmac
6129
911852ff 6130@hook TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST
38f8b050 6131This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
911852ff 6132between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
38f8b050
JR
6133if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6134This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6135If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6136registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6137
6138If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6139the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6140needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
911852ff 6141between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
38f8b050
JR
6142more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6143reflect the actual cost of the move.
6144
6145GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6146secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6147a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6148secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
61494 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6150value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6151are the same as to this target hook.
6152@end deftypefn
6153
6154@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
525d13b0
MS
6155A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6156the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6157@var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6158for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6159optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6160true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6161@code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
38f8b050
JR
6162@end defmac
6163
6164Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6165but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6166ordinarily expect.
6167
6168@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6169Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6170than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6171faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6172require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6173between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6174
6175When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6176finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6177load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6178faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6179may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6180other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6181@end defmac
6182
6183@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6184Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6185@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6186than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6187handler.
6188
6189When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6190@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6191moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6192Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6193cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6194
6195If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6196this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6197@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6198@end defmac
6199
6200@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6201The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6202which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6203string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6204make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6205
6206Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6207@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6208the number of such sequences.
6209
6210The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6211optimized for speed rather than size.
6212
6213If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6214@end defmac
6215
6216@defmac MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6217A C expression used to determine whether @code{move_by_pieces} will be used to
6218copy a chunk of memory, or whether some other block move mechanism
6219will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6220than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6221@end defmac
6222
6223@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6224A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6225a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6226@end defmac
6227
6228@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6229The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6230of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6231or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6232eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6233
6234The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6235optimized for speed rather than size.
6236
6237If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6238@end defmac
6239
6240@defmac CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6241A C expression used to determine whether @code{clear_by_pieces} will be used
6242to clear a chunk of memory, or whether some other block clear mechanism
6243will be used. Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6244than @code{CLEAR_RATIO}.
6245@end defmac
6246
6247@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6248The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6249of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
ff2ce160 6250a block set insn or a library call.
38f8b050
JR
6251Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6252eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6253
6254The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6255optimized for speed rather than size.
6256
6257If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6258@end defmac
6259
6260@defmac SET_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6261A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
ff2ce160
MS
6262used to set a chunk of memory to a constant value, or whether some
6263other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_memset} when
38f8b050
JR
6264storing values other than constant zero.
6265Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6266than @code{SET_RATIO}.
6267@end defmac
6268
6269@defmac STORE_BY_PIECES_P (@var{size}, @var{alignment})
6270A C expression used to determine whether @code{store_by_pieces} will be
6271used to set a chunk of memory to a constant string value, or whether some
6272other mechanism will be used. Used by @code{__builtin_strcpy} when
6273called with a constant source string.
6274Defaults to 1 if @code{move_by_pieces_ninsns} returns less
6275than @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6276@end defmac
6277
6278@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6279A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6280thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6281@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6282@end defmac
6283
6284@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6285A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6286thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6287@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6288@end defmac
6289
6290@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6291A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6292thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6293@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6294@end defmac
6295
6296@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6297A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6298thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6299@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6300@end defmac
6301
6302@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6303A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6304thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6305@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6306@end defmac
6307
6308@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6309A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6310thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6311@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6312@end defmac
6313
6314@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6315This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6316thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6317@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6318@end defmac
6319
6320@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6321This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6322thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6323@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6324@end defmac
6325
6326@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6327Define this macro if it is as good or better to call a constant
6328function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6329@end defmac
6330
a8d56c30
SB
6331@defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6332Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6333@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6334@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6335@end defmac
6336
38f8b050
JR
6337@hook TARGET_RTX_COSTS
6338This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6339
6340The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
68f932c4
RS
6341available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6342as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6343That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6344that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6345either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6346(b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6347
6348@var{code} is @var{x}'s expression code---redundant, since it can be
6349obtained with @code{GET_CODE (@var{x})}.
38f8b050
JR
6350
6351In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6352@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6353instructions.
6354
6355On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6356for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6357necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6358for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6359operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6360
6361When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6362false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6363size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6364
6365The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6366processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6367@end deftypefn
6368
6369@hook TARGET_ADDRESS_COST
6370This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6371@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6372the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6373
6374For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6375true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6376instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6377all addresses will have equal costs.
6378
6379In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6380the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6381cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6382
6383For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6384and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6385is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6386references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6387the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6388that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6389instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6390specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6391
6392This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6393
6394On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6395cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6396@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6397be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6398@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6399should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6400should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6401registers on machines with lots of registers.
6402@end deftypefn
6403
6404@node Scheduling
6405@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6406
6407The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6408adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6409hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6410them: try the first ones in this list first.
6411
6412@hook TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE
6413This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6414issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6415Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6416an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6417constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6418hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6419This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6420it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6421@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6422@end deftypefn
6423
6424@hook TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE
6425This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6426from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6427still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6428@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6429@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6430You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6431than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6432@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6433debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6434@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6435was scheduled.
6436@end deftypefn
6437
6438@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST
6439This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6440relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6441dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6442is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6443to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6444that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6445data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6446description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6447output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6448times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6449acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6450@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6451@end deftypefn
6452
6453@hook TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY
6454This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6455@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6456execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6457later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6458scheduling priorities of insns.
6459@end deftypefn
6460
6461@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER
6462This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6463list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6464combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6465@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6466debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6467@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6468list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6469a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6470reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6471@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6472is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6473the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6474can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6475@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6476@end deftypefn
6477
6478@hook TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2
6479Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6480function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6481is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6482@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6483return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6484this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6485scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6486cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6487@end deftypefn
6488
6489@hook TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK
6490This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6491chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6492correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6493example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6494analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6495dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6496calculated.
6497@end deftypefn
6498
6499@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT
6500This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6501instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6502pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6503is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6504@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6505region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6506scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6507@end deftypefn
6508
6509@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH
6510This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6511instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6512cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6513is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6514to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6515@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6516@end deftypefn
6517
6518@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL
6519This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6520@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6521@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6522@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6523@end deftypefn
6524
6525@hook TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL
6526This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6527@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6528@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6529@end deftypefn
6530
6531@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6532The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6533pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6534when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6535simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6536processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6537based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6538when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6539@end deftypefn
6540
6541@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN
6542The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6543@end deftypefn
6544
6545@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6546The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6547to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6548simulated processor cycle finishes.
6549@end deftypefn
6550
6551@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN
6552The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6553used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6554@end deftypefn
6555
6556@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6557The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6558The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6559to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6560state on a single insn is not enough.
6561@end deftypefn
6562
6563@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE
6564The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6565The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6566to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6567state on a single insn is not enough.
6568@end deftypefn
6569
6570@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD
6571This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6572for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6573chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6574value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6575@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6576subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6577maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6578@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6579packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6580rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6581
6582This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6583processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6584with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6585@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6586@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6587processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6588@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6589until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6590the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6591
6592Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6593pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6594schedules to choose the best one.
6595
6596The default is no multipass scheduling.
6597@end deftypefn
6598
6599@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD
6600
6601This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6602considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6603zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be not chosen to
6604be issued.
6605
6606The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6607@end deftypefn
6608
894fd6f2
MK
6609@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN
6610This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6611scheduling.
6612@end deftypefn
6613
6614@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE
6615This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6616@end deftypefn
6617
6618@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK
6619This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6620an instruction.
6621@end deftypefn
6622
6623@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END
6624This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6625round of multipass scheduling.
6626@end deftypefn
6627
6628@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT
2b0d3573 6629This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6630@end deftypefn
6631
6632@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI
2b0d3573 6633This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6634@end deftypefn
6635
c06bbdf7 6636@hook TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE
38f8b050
JR
6637This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6638on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6639@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6640the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6641is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6642start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6643verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6644@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6645processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6646and the current processor cycle.
6647@end deftypefn
6648
6649@hook TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE
6650This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6651the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6652are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6653to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6654being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6655dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6656parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6657The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6658insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6659and @code{false} otherwise.
6660
6661Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6662where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6663delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6664that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6665important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6666closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6667not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6668@end deftypefn
6669
6670@hook TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED
6671This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6672the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6673per instruction data structures.
6674@end deftypefn
6675
6676@hook TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT
6677Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6678@end deftypefn
6679
6680@hook TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT
6681Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6682It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6683beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6684@end deftypefn
6685
6686@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT
6687Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6688@end deftypefn
6689
6690@hook TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT
6691Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6692@end deftypefn
6693
6694@hook TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT
6695Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6696@end deftypefn
6697
6698@hook TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN
6699This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6700speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6701The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6702version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6703pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6704or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6705speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6706the generated speculative pattern.
6707@end deftypefn
6708
6709@hook TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P
6710This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6711for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6712instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6713@end deftypefn
6714
6715@hook TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK
6716This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6717check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6718speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6719@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6720be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6721recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6722a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6723@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6724@end deftypefn
6725
6726@hook TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD_SPEC
6727This hook is used as a workaround for
6728@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD} not being
6729called on the first instruction of the ready list. The hook is used to
6730discard speculative instructions that stand first in the ready list from
6731being scheduled on the current cycle. If the hook returns @code{false},
6732@var{insn} will not be chosen to be issued.
6733For non-speculative instructions,
6734the hook should always return @code{true}. For example, in the ia64 backend
6735the hook is used to cancel data speculative insns when the ALAT table
6736is nearly full.
6737@end deftypefn
6738
6739@hook TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS
6740This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6741enabled/used.
6742The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6743The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6744@end deftypefn
6745
6746@hook TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII
6747This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6748resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6749the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6750backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6751bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6752of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6753@end deftypefn
6754
7942e47e
RY
6755@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH
6756This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6757is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6758@end deftypefn
6759
6760@hook TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO
6761This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6762in its second parameter.
6763@end deftypefn
6764
b0bd15f7
BS
6765@hook TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6766
df7b0cc4
EI
6767@hook TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH
6768
38f8b050
JR
6769@node Sections
6770@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6771@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6772@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6773
6774An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6775data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6776section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6777section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6778section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6779of sections.
6780
6781@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6782@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6783The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6784is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6785as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6786initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6787They may however depend on command-line flags.
6788
6789@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6790use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6791to be string literals.
6792
6793Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6794section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6795should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6796@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6797
6798You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6799@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6800in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6801@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6802create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6803reuse @code{text_section}.
6804
6805All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6806if the target does not provide them.
6807
6808@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6809A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6810assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6811Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
6812@end defmac
6813
6814@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6815If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
6816frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
6817a default definition if the target supports named sections.
6818@end defmac
6819
6820@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6821If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
6822executed functions in the program.
6823@end defmac
6824
6825@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6826A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6827assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
6828data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
6829@end defmac
6830
6831@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6832If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6833containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6834initialized, writable small data.
6835@end defmac
6836
6837@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
6838A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6839assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
6840data.
6841@end defmac
6842
6843@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6844If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6845containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
07c5f94e
AS
6846uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
6847@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
38f8b050
JR
6848uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
6849@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
6850used.
6851@end defmac
6852
6853@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
6854If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6855containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6856uninitialized, writable small data.
6857@end defmac
6858
6859@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
6860If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
6861assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
6862common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
6863@end defmac
6864
6865@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
6866If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
6867containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
6868default is @code{'T'}.
6869@end defmac
6870
6871@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
6872If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6873containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6874initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6875not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
6876variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6877@end defmac
6878
6879@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
6880If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6881containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6882finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
6883not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
6884variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
6885@end defmac
6886
6887@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6888If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6889containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6890part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6891defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6892both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6893@end defmac
6894
6895@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
6896If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
6897containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
6898part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
6899defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
6900both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
6901@end defmac
6902
6903@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
6904If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
6905via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
6906the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
6907@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
6908to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
6909sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
6910ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
6911registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
6912constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
6913@end defmac
6914
6915@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
6916If defined, a string which names the section into which small
6917variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
6918when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
6919you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
6920they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
6921expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
6922MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
6923require small data support from your application, but use this macro
6924to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
6925access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
6926@end defmac
6927
6928@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
6929If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
6930arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
6931@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
6932and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
6933@end defmac
6934
6935@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
6936Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
6937tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
6938section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
6939readonly data section is used.
6940
6941This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
6942@end defmac
6943
6944@hook TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS
6945Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
6946@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
6947of its own that you need to create.
6948
6949GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
6950any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
6951described below.
6952@end deftypefn
6953
6954@hook TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK
6955Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
6956selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
6957should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
6958local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
6959
6960The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
6961is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
6962when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
6963in read-only sections even in executables.
6964@end deftypefn
6965
6966@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION
6967Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
6968assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
6969some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
6970requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
6971local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
6972@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
6973
6974The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
6975variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
6976
6977See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
6978@end deftypefn
6979
6980@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
6981Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
6982for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
6983
6984In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
6985function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
6986it is unlikely to be called.
6987@end defmac
6988
6989@hook TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION
6990Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
6991and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
6992As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
6993the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
6994
6995The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
6996ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
6997example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
6998Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
6999@end deftypefn
7000
7001@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION
7002Return the readonly data section associated with
7003@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7004The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7005the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7006if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7007otherwise.
7008@end deftypefn
7009
727a65e6
BS
7010@hook TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7011
50b0b78a
IS
7012@hook TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION
7013
38f8b050
JR
7014@hook TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION
7015Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7016should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7017constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7018case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7019in bits.
7020
7021The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7022constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7023else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7024@end deftypefn
7025
7026@hook TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7027Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7028by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7029the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7030or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7031hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7032your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7033returns the @var{id} provided.
7034@end deftypefn
7035
7036@hook TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO
7037Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7038treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7039function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7040
7041The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7042@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7043an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7044rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7045in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7046
7047In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7048a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7049will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7050register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7051rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7052leave it alone.)
7053
7054The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7055that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7056be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7057declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7058declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7059@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7060
7061@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7062The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7063@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7064Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7065encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7066discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7067
7068The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7069in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7070@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7071before overriding it.
7072@end deftypefn
7073
7074@hook TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING
7075Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7076the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7077may have added.
7078@end deftypefn
7079
7080@hook TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P
7081Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7082The default version of this hook always returns false.
7083@end deftypefn
7084
7085@hook TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7086Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7087``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7088@end deftypevr
7089
3c5273a9
KT
7090@hook TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
7091
38f8b050
JR
7092@hook TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P
7093Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7094rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7095or executable image).
7096
7097The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7098for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7099currently supported object file formats.
7100@end deftypefn
7101
7102@hook TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7103Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7104The default value is false.
7105@end deftypevr
7106
7107
7108@node PIC
7109@section Position Independent Code
7110@cindex position independent code
7111@cindex PIC
7112
7113This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7114independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7115generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7116@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7117@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7118must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7119when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7120need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7121relative addresses.
ff2ce160 7122@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
38f8b050
JR
7123@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7124
7125@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7126The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7127data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7128processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7129is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7130pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7131is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7132necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7133when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7134@end defmac
7135
7136@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
f8fe0a4a
JM
7137A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7138@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7139the default is zero. Do not define
38f8b050
JR
7140this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7141@end defmac
7142
7143@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7144A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7145operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7146You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7147check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7148check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7149(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7150position independent code.
7151@end defmac
7152
7153@node Assembler Format
7154@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7155
7156This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7157to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7158instructions do.
7159
7160@menu
7161* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7162* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7163* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7164* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7165* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7166 and termination routines.
7167* Macros for Initialization::
7168 Specific macros that control the handling of
7169 initialization and termination routines.
7170* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7171* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7172* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7173* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7174@end menu
7175
7176@node File Framework
7177@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7178@cindex assembler format
7179@cindex output of assembler code
7180
7181@c prevent bad page break with this line
7182This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7183
7184@findex default_file_start
7185@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START
7186Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7187find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7188by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7189quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7190@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7191lets other target files rely on these variables.
7192@end deftypefn
7193
7194@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7195If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7196printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7197@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7198to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7199definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7200assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7201whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7202
7203The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7204verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7205comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7206@end deftypevr
7207
7208@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7209If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7210for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7211@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7212this to be done. The default is false.
7213@end deftypevr
7214
7215@hook TARGET_ASM_FILE_END
7216Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7217to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7218@end deftypefn
7219
7220@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7221Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7222special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7223the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7224should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7225need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7226this function.
7227@end deftypefun
7228
7229@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_START
7230Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7231to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7232nothing.
7233@end deftypefn
7234
7235@hook TARGET_ASM_LTO_END
7236Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7237to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7238nothing.
7239@end deftypefn
7240
7241@hook TARGET_ASM_CODE_END
7242Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7243unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7244here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7245because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7246nothing.
7247@end deftypefn
7248
7249@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7250A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7251assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7252the end of the line.
7253@end defmac
7254
7255@defmac ASM_APP_ON
7256A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7257statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7258@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7259assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7260that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7261@end defmac
7262
7263@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7264A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7265statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7266@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7267time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7268@end defmac
7269
7270@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7271A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7272which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7273the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7274
7275This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7276for the file format in use is appropriate.
7277@end defmac
7278
b5f5d41d
AS
7279@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME
7280
a8781821
SB
7281@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT
7282
38f8b050
JR
7283@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7284A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7285@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7286in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7287the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7288of the filename using this macro.
7289@end defmac
7290
38f8b050
JR
7291@hook TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION
7292Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7293should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7294of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7295is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7296this section is associated.
7297@end deftypefn
7298
f16d3f39
JH
7299@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION
7300Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7301Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
ff2ce160 7302functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
f16d3f39
JH
7303at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7304@var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7305(from static destructors).
7306Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7307@end deftypefn
7308
14d11d40
IS
7309@hook TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS
7310
38f8b050
JR
7311@hook TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7312This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
d5fabb58 7313It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
38f8b050
JR
7314@end deftypevr
7315
7316@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7317@hook TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7318This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7319section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7320This is true on most ELF targets.
7321@end deftypevr
7322
7323@hook TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS
7324Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7325based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7326declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7327null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7328
7329The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7330read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7331need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7332set via @code{__attribute__}.
7333@end deftypefn
7334
7335@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES
7336Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7337switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7338enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7339It can take the following values:
7340
7341@table @gcctabopt
7342@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7343@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7344
7345@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7346@var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7347direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7348default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7349command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7350various different individual optimization passes.
7351
7352@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7353@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7354ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7355target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7356time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7357warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7358wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7359necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7360perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7361switches.
7362
7363@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7364This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7365
7366@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7367This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7368@end table
7369
7370The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7371supported in the future.
7372
7373By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7374provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7375it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7376section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7377provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7378hook.
7379@end deftypefn
7380
7381@hook TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7382This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7383ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7384hook.
7385@end deftypevr
7386
7387@need 2000
7388@node Data Output
7389@subsection Output of Data
7390
7391
7392@hook TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7393@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7394@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7395@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7396@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7397@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7398@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7399@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7400@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7401These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7402of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7403byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7404aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7405@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7406
7407The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7408followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7409the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7410@end deftypevr
7411
7412@hook TARGET_ASM_INTEGER
7413The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7414integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7415in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7416function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7417object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7418split the object into smaller parts.
7419
7420The default implementation of this hook will use the
7421@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7422when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7423@end deftypefn
7424
6cbd8875
AS
7425@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA
7426A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7427can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7428the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7429@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7430
7431If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7432so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7433itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7434return @code{true}.
7435@end deftypefn
7436
38f8b050
JR
7437@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7438A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7439instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7440bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7441@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7442
7443If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7444Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7445@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7446@end defmac
7447
7448@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7449A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7450@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7451is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7452@end defmac
7453
7454@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7455You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7456expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7457pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7458GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7459not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7460pool before the function.
7461@end defmac
7462
7463@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7464A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7465constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7466the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7467be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7468is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7469immediately after this call.
7470
7471If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7472not be defined.
7473@end defmac
7474
7475@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7476A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7477constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7478anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7479
7480The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7481assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7482output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7483@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7484@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7485alignment.
7486
7487The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7488the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7489responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7490Here is how to do this:
7491
7492@smallexample
7493@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7494@end smallexample
7495
7496When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7497@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7498entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7499
7500You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7501@end defmac
7502
7503@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7504A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7505pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7506function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7507obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7508constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7509
7510If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7511define this macro.
7512@end defmac
7513
7514@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7515Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7516used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7517to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7518a line separator uses multiple characters.
7519
7520If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7521the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7522@end defmac
7523
7524@hook TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7525These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7526assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7527default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7528@end deftypevr
7529
7530These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7531of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7532
7533@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7534@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7535@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7536@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7537@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7538@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7539These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7540target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7541the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7542@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7543simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7544@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7545by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7546it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
754732 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7548on the host machine.
7549
7550The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7551using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7552machine's memory.
7553@end defmac
7554
7555@node Uninitialized Data
7556@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7557
7558Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7559outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7560
7561@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7562A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7563@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7564@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7565is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7566possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7567other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7568backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7569byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7570equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7571the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7572an ordinary undefined external.
7573
7574Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7575output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7576assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7577
7578This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7579common global variables are output.
7580@end defmac
7581
7582@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7583Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7584separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7585place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7586handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7587as the number of bits.
7588@end defmac
7589
7590@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7591Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7592variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7593is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7594in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7595@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7596the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7597@end defmac
7598
07c5f94e 7599@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
38f8b050
JR
7600A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7601@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
07c5f94e
AS
7602@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7603is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
38f8b050 7604
07c5f94e
AS
7605Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7606@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
38f8b050
JR
7607@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7608before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7609the name, and a newline.
7610
07c5f94e 7611There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
38f8b050
JR
7612The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7613switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7614You do not need to do both.
7615
7616Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7617non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7618efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7619not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7620common in order to save space in the object file.
7621@end defmac
7622
38f8b050
JR
7623@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7624A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7625@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7626@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7627is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7628
7629Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7630output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7631assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7632
7633This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7634static variables are output.
7635@end defmac
7636
7637@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7638Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7639separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7640place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7641handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7642as the number of bits.
7643@end defmac
7644
7645@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7646Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7647variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7648is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7649in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7650@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7651the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7652@end defmac
7653
7654@node Label Output
7655@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7656
7657@c prevent bad page break with this line
7658This is about outputting labels.
7659
7660@findex assemble_name
7661@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7662A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7663@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7664Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7665output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7666assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7667definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7668@end defmac
7669
135a687e
KT
7670@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7671A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7672@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7673a function.
7674Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7675output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7676assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7677definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7678
7679If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7680usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7681@end defmac
7682
38f8b050
JR
7683@findex assemble_name_raw
7684@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7685Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7686to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7687@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7688that it is more efficient.
7689@end defmac
7690
7691@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7692A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7693size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7694default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7695systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7696
7697Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7698of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7699for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7700macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7701define this macro.
7702@end defmac
7703
7704@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7705A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7706@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7707symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7708If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7709provided.
7710@end defmac
7711
7712@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7713A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7714@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7715the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7716address.
7717
7718If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7719provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7720@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7721the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7722not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7723to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7724@end defmac
7725
7726@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7727A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7728type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7729default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7730systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7731
7732Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7733@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7734custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7735types at all, do not define this macro.
7736@end defmac
7737
7738@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7739A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7740the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7741default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7742the default is not to define this macro.
7743
7744Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7745@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7746custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7747types at all, do not define this macro.
7748@end defmac
7749
7750@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7751A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7752@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7753symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7754that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7755you should not count on this.
7756
7757If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7758definition of this macro is provided.
7759@end defmac
7760
7761@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7762A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7763@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7764function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7765outputting the label definition (perhaps using
135a687e 7766@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
38f8b050
JR
7767@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7768
7769If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
135a687e 7770usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
38f8b050
JR
7771
7772You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
7773of this macro.
7774@end defmac
7775
7776@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7777A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7778@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
7779which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
7780function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
7781representing the function.
7782
7783If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
7784
7785You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
7786of this macro.
7787@end defmac
7788
7789@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7790A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7791@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
7792initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
7793label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
7794@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
7795
7796If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
7797usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7798
7799You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7800@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
7801@end defmac
7802
ad78130c 7803@hook TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME
38f8b050
JR
7804A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
7805for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
7806target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
7807@code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
7808and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
7809will be an internal label.
7810
7811The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
7812usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
7813
7814You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
7815@end deftypefn
7816
7817@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
7818A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7819@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
7820for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
7821
7822If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7823nothing.
7824@end defmac
7825
7826@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
7827A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
7828once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
7829chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
7830initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
7831something about the size of the object.
7832
7833If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
7834nothing.
7835
7836You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
7837@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
7838@end defmac
7839
7840@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL
7841This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7842@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
7843that is, available for reference from other files.
7844
7845The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
7846@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
7847@end deftypefn
7848
7849@hook TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME
7850This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
7851@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
7852global; that is, available for reference from other files.
7853
7854The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
7855@end deftypefn
7856
7857@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7858A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7859@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
7860that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
7861no other definition is available. Use the expression
7862@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
7863itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
7864for making that name weak, and a newline.
7865
7866If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
7867support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
7868macro.
7869@end defmac
7870
7871@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7872Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
7873@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
7874or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
7875should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
7876defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
7877@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
7878to make @var{name} weak.
7879@end defmac
7880
7881@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
7882Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
7883symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
7884declaration of @code{name}.
7885@end defmac
7886
7887@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
74b90fe2
JDA
7888A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
7889supports weak symbols.
38f8b050
JR
7890
7891If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7892definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
74b90fe2
JDA
7893is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
7894@end defmac
7895
7896@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
7897A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
7898
7899If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
7900definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
7901this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
7902flag such as @option{-melf}.
38f8b050
JR
7903@end defmac
7904
7905@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
7906A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
7907public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
7908be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
7909format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
7910section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
7911requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
7912@end defmac
7913
7914@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
7915A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
7916semantics.
7917
7918If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
7919definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
7920definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
7921you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
7922setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
7923be emitted as one-only.
7924@end defmac
7925
7926@hook TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY
7927This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
7928commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
7929hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
7930@end deftypefn
7931
7932@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
7933A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
7934that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
7935The default is @code{0}.
7936
7937Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
7938if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
7939will have undefined references from other translation units, that
7940symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
7941thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
7942(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
7943with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
7944
7945The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
7946targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
7947restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
7948table of contents.
7949@end defmac
7950
7951@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
7952A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7953@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
7954symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
7955not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
7956declaration.
7957
7958This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
7959The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
7960@end defmac
7961
7962@hook TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL
7963This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7964pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
7965library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
7966@end deftypefn
7967
7968@hook TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED
7969This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
7970directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
7971.no_dead_code_strip directive.
7972@end deftypefn
7973
7974@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7975A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7976@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
7977@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
7978is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
7979systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
7980@end defmac
7981
77754180
DK
7982@hook TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME
7983
38f8b050
JR
7984@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
7985A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
7986@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
7987will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
7988to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
7989encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
7990@end defmac
7991
7992@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
7993A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
7994result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
7995@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
7996This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
7997specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
7998when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
7999being taken.
8000@end defmac
8001
8002@hook TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL
8003A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8004name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8005
8006It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8007used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8008will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8009
8010It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8011object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8012should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8013beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8014convention your system uses, and follow it.
8015
8016The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8017@end deftypefn
8018
8019@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8020A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8021label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8022@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8023may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8024systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8025bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8026bundles.
8027
8028If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8029used.
8030@end defmac
8031
8032@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8033A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8034is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8035
8036This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8037produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8038with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8039
8040If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8041output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8042@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8043string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8044to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8045@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8046you should know what it does on your machine.)
8047@end defmac
8048
8049@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8050A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8051@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8052@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8053added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8054
8055The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8056produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8057@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8058assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8059macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8060internal static variables in different scopes.
8061
8062Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8063conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8064or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8065between the name and the number will suffice.
8066
8067If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8068which is correct for most systems.
8069@end defmac
8070
8071@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8072A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8073which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8074
8075@findex SET_ASM_OP
8076If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8077correct for most systems.
8078@end defmac
8079
8080@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8081A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8082which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8083to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8084be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8085the tree nodes are available.
8086
8087@findex SET_ASM_OP
8088If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8089correct for most systems.
8090@end defmac
8091
8092@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8093A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8094(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8095of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8096current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8097This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8098@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8099@end defmac
8100
8101@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8102A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8103which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8104@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8105an undefined weak symbol.
8106
8107Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8108@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8109@end defmac
8110
8111@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8112Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8113Objective-C methods.
8114
8115The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8116class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8117the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8118@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8119
8120These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8121the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8122systems define other ways of computing names.
8123
8124@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8125buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8126@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
812750 characters extra.
8128
8129The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8130method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8131@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8132in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8133
8134On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8135macro to provide more human-readable names.
8136@end defmac
8137
38f8b050
JR
8138@node Initialization
8139@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8140@cindex initialization routines
8141@cindex termination routines
8142@cindex constructors, output of
8143@cindex destructors, output of
8144
8145The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8146(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8147data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8148to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8149@code{main} is called.
8150
8151Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8152@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8153terminates.
8154
8155To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8156must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8157be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8158system, you need to specify how to do this.
8159
8160There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8161initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8162Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8163
8164@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8165@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8166The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8167initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8168termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8169
8170Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
81710, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8172the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8173pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8174pointer containing zero.
8175
8176Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8177@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8178time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8179list; destructors in forward order.
8180
8181The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8182formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8183aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8184Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8185object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8186the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8187accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8188Termination functions are handled similarly.
8189
8190This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8191@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8192support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8193constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8194and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8195
8196When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8197upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8198support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8199parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8200program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8201
8202@smallexample
8203ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8204@end smallexample
8205
8206The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8207section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8208for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8209files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8210are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8211
8212The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8213compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8214fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8215to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8216of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8217that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8218
8219To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8220macro properly.
8221
8222If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8223@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8224entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8225it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8226after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8227in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8228
8229In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8230two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8231and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8232@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8233entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8234and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8235code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8236the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8237placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8238a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8239@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8240section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8241the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8242the initialization process.
8243
8244The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8245This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8246file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8247this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8248termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8249an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8250pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8251the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8252initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8253via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8254@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8255
8256@ifinfo
8257The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8258customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8259@end ifinfo
8260
8261@node Macros for Initialization
8262@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8263
8264Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8265and termination functions:
8266
8267@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8268If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8269operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8270defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8271using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8272macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8273run the initialization functions.
8274@end defmac
8275
8276@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8277If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8278This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8279on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8280be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8281@end defmac
8282
8283@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8284If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8285the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8286@end defmac
8287
8288@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8289If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8290the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8291@end defmac
8292
8293@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8294If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8295automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8296should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8297the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8298function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8299
8300This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8301shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8302exception tables embedded in the code.
8303@end defmac
8304
8305@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8306If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8307automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8308should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8309the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8310function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8311@end defmac
8312
8313@defmac INVOKE__main
8314If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8315@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8316where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8317useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8318@end defmac
8319
8320@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8321If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8322compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8323of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8324encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8325@end defmac
8326
8327@hook TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8328This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8329collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8330It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8331@end deftypevr
8332
8333@hook TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR
8334If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8335the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8336
8337Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8338no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8339priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8340otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8341
8342If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8343be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8344target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8345is not defined.
8346@end deftypefn
8347
8348@hook TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR
8349This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8350functions rather than initialization functions.
8351@end deftypefn
8352
8353If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8354generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8355
8356If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8357constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8358an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8359
8360On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8361@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8362
8363@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8364Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8365object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8366object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8367
8368This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8369part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8370@end defmac
8371
8372@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8373Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8374to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8375@command{nm}.
3e794bfe
RO
8376@end defmac
8377
8378@defmac NM_FLAGS
8379@command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8380constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8381passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
2b0d3573 8382are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
3e794bfe
RO
8383produces.
8384@end defmac
38f8b050
JR
8385
8386If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8387dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8388these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8389termination functions in shared libraries:
38f8b050
JR
8390
8391@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8392Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
3e794bfe 8393which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
38f8b050
JR
8394@end defmac
8395
8396@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8397Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8398of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8399of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8400from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8401code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8402line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8403@end defmac
8404
8405@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8406Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8407library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8408strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8409constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8410that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8411@end defmac
8412
8413@node Instruction Output
8414@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8415
8416@c prevent bad page break with this line
8417This describes assembler instruction output.
8418
8419@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8420A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8421registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8422register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8423@end defmac
8424
8425@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8426If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8427and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8428registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8429to registers using alternate names.
8430@end defmac
8431
0c6d290e
RE
8432@defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8433If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8434name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8435machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8436names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8437declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8438@code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8439register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8440
8441This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8442@code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8443register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8444VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8445``s0'' and ``s1''.
8446@end defmac
8447
38f8b050
JR
8448@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8449Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8450requires different names for the machine instructions.
8451
8452The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8453assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8454macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8455points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8456written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8457opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8458increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8459so that it will not be output twice.
8460
8461In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8462name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8463that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8464care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8465@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8466
8467@findex recog_data.operand
8468If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8469elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8470
8471If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8472in the usual way.
8473@end defmac
8474
8475@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8476If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8477assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8478they will be output differently.
8479
8480Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8481extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8482elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8483The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8484template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8485by changing the contents of the vector.
8486
8487This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8488file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8489can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8490as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8491syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8492writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8493
8494If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8495@end defmac
8496
8497@hook TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN
8498If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8499output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8500if necessary.
8501
8502Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8503extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8504elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8505The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8506template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8507by checking the contents of the vector.
8508@end deftypefn
8509
8510@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8511A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8512assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8513RTL expression.
8514
8515@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8516of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8517printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8518the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8519operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8520@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8521@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8522
8523@findex reg_names
8524If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8525The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8526@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8527@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8528
8529When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8530(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8531with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8532@var{code}.
8533@end defmac
8534
8535@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8536A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8537punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8538@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8539punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8540in this way.
8541@end defmac
8542
8543@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8544A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8545assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8546whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8547
8548@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8549On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8550section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8551@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8552@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8553Format}.
8554@end defmac
8555
8556@findex dbr_sequence_length
8557@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8558A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8559been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8560determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8561currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8562or whatever.
8563
8564Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8565reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8566explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8567@end defmac
8568
8569@findex final_sequence
8570Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8571prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8572(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8573found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8574processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8575being output.
8576
8577@findex asm_fprintf
8578@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8579@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8580@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8581@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8582If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8583@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8584@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8585support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8586files can define these macros differently.
8587@end defmac
8588
8589@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8590If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8591statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8592the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8593printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8594statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8595generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8596specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8597The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8598string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8599upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8600@end defmac
8601
8602@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8603If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8604different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8605numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8606first variant.
8607
8608If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8609@smallexample
8610@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8611@end smallexample
8612@noindent
8613in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8614first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8615@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8616@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8617within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8618alternatives within the braces than the value of
8619@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing.
8620
8621If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8622@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8623operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8624
8625Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8626@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8627the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8628@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8629if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8630opcodes or operand order.
8631@end defmac
8632
8633@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8634A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8635which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8636The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8637profiling.
8638@end defmac
8639
8640@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8641A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8642which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8643The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8644profiling.
8645@end defmac
8646
8647@node Dispatch Tables
8648@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8649
8650@c prevent bad page break with this line
8651This concerns dispatch tables.
8652
8653@cindex dispatch table
8654@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8655A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8656pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8657@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8658definitions of these labels are output using
8659@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8660way here. For example,
8661
8662@smallexample
8663fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8664 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8665@end smallexample
8666
8667You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8668dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8669will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8670@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8671mode and flags can be read.
8672@end defmac
8673
8674@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8675This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8676in a dispatch table are absolute.
8677
8678The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8679@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8680a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8681definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8682For example,
8683
8684@smallexample
8685fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8686@end smallexample
8687@end defmac
8688
8689@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8690Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8691specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8692@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8693jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_insn} containing an
8694@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8695
8696This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8697for the table.
8698
8699If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8700@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8701@end defmac
8702
8703@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8704Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8705jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8706after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8707the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8708@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8709of the preceding label.
8710
8711If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8712the jump-table.
8713@end defmac
8714
8715@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL
8716This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8717should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8718should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8719function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8720The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8721exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8722true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8723
8724The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8725@end deftypefn
8726
8727@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL
8728This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8729It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8730to be broken up according to function.
8731
8732The default is that no label is emitted.
8733@end deftypefn
8734
a68b5e52
RH
8735@hook TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY
8736
38f8b050
JR
8737@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT
8738This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
f0a0390e
RH
8739given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
8740returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
38f8b050
JR
8741@end deftypefn
8742
3bc6b3e6
RH
8743@hook TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
8744
38f8b050
JR
8745@node Exception Region Output
8746@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
8747
8748@c prevent bad page break with this line
8749
8750This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
8751region.
8752
8753@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
8754If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
8755exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
8756provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
8757@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
8758
8759You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
8760unwind information and the default definition does not work.
8761@end defmac
8762
8763@defmac EH_FRAME_IN_DATA_SECTION
8764If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will be placed in the
8765data section even though the target supports named sections. This
8766might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker does garbage
8767collection and sections cannot be marked as not to be collected.
8768
8769Do not define this macro unless @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is
8770also defined.
8771@end defmac
8772
8773@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
8774Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
8775information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
8776runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
8777and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
8778@end defmac
8779
8780@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
8781An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
8782that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
8783@end defmac
8784
8785@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
8786Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8787information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
8788Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
01a07a64
SB
8789@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
8790GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
f0a0390e 8791@end defmac
38f8b050 8792
f0a0390e
RH
8793@hook TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO
8794This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
8795by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
8796should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
8797@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
8798should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
8799information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
38f8b050 8800
f0a0390e
RH
8801A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
8802This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
8803default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
38f8b050 8804
f0a0390e 8805Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
d5fabb58
JM
8806not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
8807@var{opts}. In particular, the
f0a0390e
RH
8808setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
8809macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
8810depending on this setting.
8811
8812The default implementation of the hook first honors the
8813@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
d5fabb58
JM
8814@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
8815@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
8816must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
f0a0390e 8817@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8818
8819@hook TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
8820This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
d5fabb58
JM
8821tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
8822command-line option processing.
38f8b050
JR
8823@end deftypevr
8824
38f8b050
JR
8825@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
8826Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
8827should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
8828instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
8829@end defmac
8830
39ce30d8
SB
8831@defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
8832This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
8833defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
8834for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
8835is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
8836The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
8837@end defmac
8838
38f8b050
JR
8839@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
8840This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
8841function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
8842@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
8843alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and the positive
8844minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
8845the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
8846@end defmac
8847
8848@hook TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
8849Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
8850end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
8851Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
8852true otherwise.
8853@end deftypevr
8854
8855@hook TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN
8856Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
8857represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
8858register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
8859locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
8860register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8861If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
8862@end deftypefn
8863
8864@hook TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA
8865If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
8866multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
8867sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
8868It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
8869filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
8870@var{address} is the address of the table.
8871@end deftypefn
8872
8873@hook TARGET_ASM_TTYPE
8874This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
8875the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
8876if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
8877reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
8878@end deftypefn
8879
8880@hook TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
8881This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
8882based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
8883the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
8884running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
8885@end deftypevr
8886
8887@node Alignment Output
8888@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
8889
8890@c prevent bad page break with this line
8891This describes commands for alignment.
8892
8893@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8894The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
8895a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
8896
8897This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8898to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8899define the macro.
8900
8901Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8902to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
8903@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8904selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
8905@end defmac
8906
ad0c4c36
DD
8907@hook TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8908The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
8909@code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
8910@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
8911@end deftypefn
8912
38f8b050
JR
8913@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
8914The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8915a @code{BARRIER}.
8916
8917This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8918to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8919define the macro.
8920@end defmac
8921
ad0c4c36
DD
8922@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP
8923The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
38f8b050
JR
8924@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
8925@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
ad0c4c36 8926@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8927
8928@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
8929The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
8930a @code{NOTE_INSN_LOOP_BEG} note.
8931
8932This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
8933to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
8934define the macro.
8935
8936Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8937to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
8938@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8939selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
8940@end defmac
8941
ad0c4c36
DD
8942@hook TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8943The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
8944@var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
8945defined.
8946@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8947
8948@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
8949The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
8950If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
8951the maximum of the specified values is used.
8952
8953Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
8954to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
8955@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
8956selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
8957@end defmac
8958
ad0c4c36
DD
8959@hook TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP
8960The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
8961to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
8962is defined.
8963@end deftypefn
38f8b050
JR
8964
8965@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
8966A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8967instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
8968Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
8969expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8970@end defmac
8971
8972@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
8973Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
8974text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
8975This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
8976produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
8977section.
8978@end defmac
8979
8980@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8981A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8982command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8983@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
8984@end defmac
8985
8986@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8987Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
8988for padding, if necessary.
8989@end defmac
8990
8991@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
8992A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8993command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
8994@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
8995satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
8996a C expression of type @code{int}.
8997@end defmac
8998
8999@need 3000
9000@node Debugging Info
9001@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9002
9003@c prevent bad page break with this line
9004This describes how to specify debugging information.
9005
9006@menu
9007* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9008* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9009* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9010* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9011* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9012* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9013@end menu
9014
9015@node All Debuggers
9016@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9017
9018@c prevent bad page break with this line
9019These macros affect all debugging formats.
9020
9021@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9022A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9023register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9024of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9025some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9026versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9027compiler and another for DBX@.
9028
9029If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9030used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9031consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9032Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9033expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9034
9035If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9036does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9037redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9038@end defmac
9039
9040@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9041A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9042variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9043computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9044gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9045that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9046for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9047@option{-g} options is used.
9048@end defmac
9049
9050@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9051A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9052having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9053@var{offset}.
9054@end defmac
9055
9056@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9057A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9058produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9059this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9060debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9061@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9062@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9063
9064When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9065value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9066exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9067value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9068defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9069
9070The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9071user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9072@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9073@end defmac
9074
9075@node DBX Options
9076@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9077
9078@c prevent bad page break with this line
9079These are specific options for DBX output.
9080
9081@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9082Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9083in response to the @option{-g} option.
9084@end defmac
9085
9086@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9087Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9088in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9089@end defmac
9090
9091@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9092Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9093GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9094debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9095macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9096if there is any occasion to.
9097@end defmac
9098
9099@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9100Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9101in the text section.
9102@end defmac
9103
9104@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9105A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9106use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9107If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9108applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9109@end defmac
9110
9111@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9112A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9113use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9114value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9115@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9116information format.
9117@end defmac
9118
9119@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9120A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9121use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9122name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9123macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9124@end defmac
9125
9126@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9127Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9128@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9129describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9130On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9131@end defmac
9132
9133@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9134A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9135continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9136exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9137operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9138must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9139with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9140defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9141@end defmac
9142
9143@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9144Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9145the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9146a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9147constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9148if backslash is correct for your system.
9149@end defmac
9150
9151@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9152Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9153outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9154variable.
9155@end defmac
9156
9157@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9158The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9159for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9160@end defmac
9161
9162@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9163The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9164for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9165provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9166@end defmac
9167
9168@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9169The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9170for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9171``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9172@end defmac
9173
9174@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9175The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9176passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9177do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9178@end defmac
9179
9180@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9181Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9182arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9183in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9184code.
9185@end defmac
9186
9187@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9188Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9189the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9190relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9191an absolute address.
9192@end defmac
9193
9194@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9195Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9196the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9197start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9198@end defmac
9199
9200@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9201Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9202@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9203macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9204number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9205generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9206number for a type number.
9207@end defmac
9208
9209@node DBX Hooks
9210@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9211
9212@c prevent bad page break with this line
9213These are hooks for DBX format.
9214
38f8b050
JR
9215@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9216A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9217number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9218@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9219invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9220unique labels in the assembly output.
9221
9222This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9223if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9224@end defmac
9225
9226@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9227Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9228@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9229On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9230disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9231@end defmac
9232
9233@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9234Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9235extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9236feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9237@end defmac
9238
9239@node File Names and DBX
9240@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9241
9242@c prevent bad page break with this line
9243This describes file names in DBX format.
9244
9245@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9246A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9247@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9248file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9249This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9250
9251This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9252for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9253
9254It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9255text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9256to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9257@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9258@end defmac
9259
9260@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9261Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9262of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9263the beginning of the file.
9264@end defmac
9265
9266@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9267Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9268that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9269an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9270@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9271@end defmac
9272
9273@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9274A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9275compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9276written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9277
9278If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9279of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9280@end defmac
9281
9282@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9283Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9284@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9285the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9286whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9287@end defmac
9288
9289@need 2000
9290@node SDB and DWARF
9291@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9292
9293@c prevent bad page break with this line
9294Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9295
9296@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9297Define this macro if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9298for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9299@end defmac
9300
9301@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9302Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9303debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9304
9305@hook TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION
9306Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9307be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9308value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9309@end deftypefn
9310
9311To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9312define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9313@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9314prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9315as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9316@end defmac
9317
9318@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9319Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
f0a0390e
RH
9320Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9321(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9322exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9323how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
38f8b050
JR
9324@end defmac
9325
f0a0390e
RH
9326@hook TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO
9327This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9328unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9329@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9330return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9331
9332A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9333is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9334
9335A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9336This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9337@end deftypefn
9338
38f8b050
JR
9339@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9340Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9341line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9342tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9343@end defmac
9344
9730bc27
TT
9345@hook TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9346
638c962f
JH
9347@hook TARGET_FORCE_AT_COMP_DIR
9348
2ba42841
AO
9349@hook TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9350
9351@hook TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9352
38f8b050
JR
9353@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9354A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9355@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9356@end defmac
9357
9358@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9359A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9360between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9361slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9362@end defmac
9363
9364@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9365A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9366section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9367given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9368@end defmac
9369
9370@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9371A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9372reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9373@end defmac
9374
9375@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9376A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9377the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9378is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9379is referenced by a function.
9380@end defmac
9381
9382@hook TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL
9383If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9384reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9385@end deftypefn
9386
9387@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9388Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9389SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9390macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9391not define them yourself.
9392@end defmac
9393
9394@defmac SDB_DELIM
9395Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9396SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9397delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9398a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9399required.
9400@end defmac
9401
9402@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9403Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9404union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9405allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9406it.
9407@end defmac
9408
9409@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9410Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9411enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9412assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9413@end defmac
9414
9415@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9416A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9417number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9418@var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9419@end defmac
9420
9421@need 2000
9422@node VMS Debug
9423@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9424
9425@c prevent bad page break with this line
9426Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9427
9428@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9429Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9430in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9431is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9432@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
fac0f722 9433behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
38f8b050
JR
9434@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9435@end defmac
9436
9437@node Floating Point
9438@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9439@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9440@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9441
9442While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9443there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9444means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9445in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9446doing the compilation.
9447
9448Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9449range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9450the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9451safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9452the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9453emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9454target floating point formats are identical.
9455
9456The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9457use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9458floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9459their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9460
9461@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9462The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9463machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9464array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9465quantity.
9466@end defmac
9467
9468@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9469Compares for equality the two values, @var{x} and @var{y}. If the target
9470floating point format supports negative zeroes and/or NaNs,
9471@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (-0.0, 0.0)} is true, and
9472@samp{REAL_VALUES_EQUAL (NaN, NaN)} is false.
9473@end deftypefn
9474
9475@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUES_LESS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9476Tests whether @var{x} is less than @var{y}.
9477@end deftypefn
9478
9479@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9480Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9481@end deftypefn
9482
9483@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9484Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9485@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9486@end deftypefn
9487
9488@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9489Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9490representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9491decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9492defined by the C language for both.
9493@end deftypefn
9494
9495@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9496Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9497@end deftypefn
9498
9499@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9500Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9501@end deftypefn
9502
9503@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9504Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9505@end deftypefn
9506
9507@deftypefn Macro void REAL_ARITHMETIC (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{output}, enum tree_code @var{code}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{y})
9508Calculates an arithmetic operation on the two floating point values
9509@var{x} and @var{y}, storing the result in @var{output} (which must be a
9510variable).
9511
9512The operation to be performed is specified by @var{code}. Only the
9513following codes are supported: @code{PLUS_EXPR}, @code{MINUS_EXPR},
9514@code{MULT_EXPR}, @code{RDIV_EXPR}, @code{MAX_EXPR}, @code{MIN_EXPR}.
9515
9516If @code{REAL_ARITHMETIC} is asked to evaluate division by zero and the
9517target's floating point format cannot represent infinity, it will call
9518@code{abort}. Callers should check for this situation first, using
9519@code{MODE_HAS_INFINITIES}. @xref{Storage Layout}.
9520@end deftypefn
9521
9522@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9523Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9524@end deftypefn
9525
9526@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9527Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9528@end deftypefn
9529
38f8b050
JR
9530@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_TO_INT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9531Converts a floating point value @var{x} into a double-precision integer
9532which is then stored into @var{low} and @var{high}. If the value is not
9533integral, it is truncated.
9534@end deftypefn
9535
9536@deftypefn Macro void REAL_VALUE_FROM_INT (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{low}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{high}, enum machine_mode @var{mode})
9537Converts a double-precision integer found in @var{low} and @var{high},
9538into a floating point value which is then stored into @var{x}. The
9539value is truncated to fit in mode @var{mode}.
9540@end deftypefn
9541
9542@node Mode Switching
9543@section Mode Switching Instructions
9544@cindex mode switching
9545The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9546
9547@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9548Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9549switching in an optimizing compilation.
9550
9551For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9552floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9553the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9554operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9555purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9556be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9557or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9558
9559You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9560which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9561return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9562If you define this macro, you also have to define
9563@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{MODE_NEEDED},
9564@code{MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE} and @code{EMIT_MODE_SET}.
9565@code{MODE_AFTER}, @code{MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{MODE_EXIT}
9566are optional.
9567@end defmac
9568
9569@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9570If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9571initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9572N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9573of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9574The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9575zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9576entity in question.
9577In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9578represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9579switch is needed / supplied.
9580@end defmac
9581
9582@defmac MODE_NEEDED (@var{entity}, @var{insn})
9583@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9584@code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to
9585return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in
9586@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must
9587be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9588@end defmac
9589
9786913b
UB
9590@defmac MODE_AFTER (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{insn})
9591@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If
9592this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during
38f8b050
JR
9593mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if
9594different from the incoming mode).
9595@end defmac
9596
9597@defmac MODE_ENTRY (@var{entity})
9598If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9599mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9600@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{MODE_ENTRY}
9601is defined then @code{MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9602@end defmac
9603
9604@defmac MODE_EXIT (@var{entity})
9605If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs
9606mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that
9607@var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{MODE_EXIT}
9608is defined then @code{MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9609@end defmac
9610
9611@defmac MODE_PRIORITY_TO_MODE (@var{entity}, @var{n})
9612This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed.
96130 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the
9614lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode
9615for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority_to_mode}
9616(@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{}
9617@code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9618@end defmac
9619
9620@defmac EMIT_MODE_SET (@var{entity}, @var{mode}, @var{hard_regs_live})
9621Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}.
9622@var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where
9623the insn(s) are to be inserted.
9624@end defmac
9625
9626@node Target Attributes
9627@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9628@cindex target attributes
9629@cindex machine attributes
9630@cindex attributes, target-specific
9631
9632Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9633These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9634be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9635
9636@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9637If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9638attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree.h}) specifying the machine
9639specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9640entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9641take.
9642@end deftypevr
9643
9644@hook TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P
9645If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9646machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9647given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9648subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9649false for all machine-specific attributes.
9650@end deftypefn
9651
9652@hook TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9653If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9654@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9655and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9656generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9657supposed always to be compatible.
9658@end deftypefn
9659
9660@hook TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9661If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9662the newly defined @var{type}.
9663@end deftypefn
9664
9665@hook TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
9666Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9667handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9668@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9669that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9670function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9671merging.
9672@end deftypefn
9673
9674@hook TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9675Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9676handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9677@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9678@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9679when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9680attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9681call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9682
9683@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9684If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9685for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9686@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9687will then define a function called
9688@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9689the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9690add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9691to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9692@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9693@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9694@end deftypefn
9695
9696@hook TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P
9697
9698@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9699Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9700@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9701default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9702@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9703of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9704on this implementation detail.
9705@end defmac
9706
9707@hook TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES
9708Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9709when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9710wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9711the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9712created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9713for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9714shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9715the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9716attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9717needed.
9718@end deftypefn
9719
9720@hook TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P
9721@cindex inlining
9722This target hook returns @code{true} if it is ok to inline @var{fndecl}
9723into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9724attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9725target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9726@end deftypefn
9727
9728@hook TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P
9729This hook is called to parse the @code{attribute(option("..."))}, and
9730it allows the function to set different target machine compile time
9731options for the current function that might be different than the
9732options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9733@code{true} if the options are valid.
9734
9735The hook should set the @var{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9736the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target specific
9737@var{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9738@end deftypefn
9739
9740@hook TARGET_OPTION_SAVE
9741This hook is called to save any additional target specific information
9742in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for function specific
9743options.
9744@xref{Option file format}.
9745@end deftypefn
9746
9747@hook TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE
9748This hook is called to restore any additional target specific
9749information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9750function specific options.
9751@end deftypefn
9752
9753@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRINT
9754This hook is called to print any additional target specific
9755information in the @var{struct cl_target_option} structure for
9756function specific options.
9757@end deftypefn
9758
56cb42ea 9759@hook TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE
38f8b050
JR
9760This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC option} to
9761set the machine specific options for functions that occur later in the
9762input stream. The options should be the same as handled by the
56cb42ea 9763@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
38f8b050
JR
9764@end deftypefn
9765
9766@hook TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE
9767Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
9768a particular target machine. You can override the hook
9769@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
9770once just after all the command options have been parsed.
9771
9772Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
fac0f722 9773@option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
38f8b050
JR
9774
9775If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
9776changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
9777@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
9778@end deftypefn
9779
9780@hook TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P
9781This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
9782cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
9783default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
9784specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
9785@end deftypefn
9786
9787@node Emulated TLS
9788@section Emulating TLS
9789@cindex Emulated TLS
9790
9791For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
9792specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
9793used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
9794configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
9795the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
9796layer.
9797
9798The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
9799object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
9800which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
9801address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
9802
9803@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
9804Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
9805object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
9806emulated TLS helper function to be used.
9807@end deftypevr
9808
9809@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
9810Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
9811program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
9812initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
9813have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
9814registration function to be used.
9815@end deftypevr
9816
9817@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
9818Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
9819be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
9820any section.
9821@end deftypevr
9822
9823@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
9824Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
9825placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
9826section.
9827@end deftypevr
9828
9829@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
9830Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
9831The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9832@end deftypevr
9833
9834@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
9835Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
9836default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
9837@end deftypevr
9838
9839@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS
9840Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
9841object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
9842@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
9843@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
9844for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
9845@end deftypefn
9846
9847@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT
9848Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
9849TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
9850is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
9851initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
9852@end deftypefn
9853
9854@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
9855Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
9856fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
9857single objects. The default is false.
9858@end deftypevr
9859
9860@hook TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
9861Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
9862may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
9863@end deftypevr
9864
9865@node MIPS Coprocessors
9866@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
9867@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
9868
9869The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
9870coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
9871accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
9872and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
9873
9874@smallexample
9875 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
9876 unsigned int d;
9877
9878 d = cp0count + 3;
9879@end smallexample
9880
9881(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
9882names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
9883overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
9884
9885Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
9886be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
9887later in the function.
9888
9889Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
9890the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
9891floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
9892
9893There is one macro used in defining the MIPS coprocessor interface which
9894you may want to override in subtargets; it is described below.
9895
38f8b050
JR
9896@node PCH Target
9897@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
9898@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
9899
9900@hook TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY
9901This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
9902@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
9903@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
9904@end deftypefn
9905
9906@hook TARGET_PCH_VALID_P
9907This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
9908compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
9909if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
9910be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
9911
9912@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
9913when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
9914It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
9915compiler, so no format checking is needed.
9916
9917The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
9918suitable for most targets.
9919@end deftypefn
9920
9921@hook TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS
9922If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
9923@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
9924of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
9925@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
9926value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
9927@end deftypefn
9928
e32ea2d1
RS
9929@hook TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE
9930
38f8b050
JR
9931@node C++ ABI
9932@section C++ ABI parameters
9933@cindex parameters, c++ abi
9934
9935@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE
9936Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
9937These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
9938default is long_long_integer_type_node.
9939@end deftypefn
9940
9941@hook TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT
9942This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
9943@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
9944@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
9945@end deftypefn
9946
9947@hook TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE
9948This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
9949whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
9950known that a cookie is needed. The default is
9951@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
9952IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
9953@end deftypefn
9954
9955@hook TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE
9956This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
9957array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
9958@end deftypefn
9959
9960@hook TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS
9961If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
9962class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
9963will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
9964to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
9965modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
9966backend's targeted operating system.
9967@end deftypefn
9968
9969@hook TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS
9970This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
9971the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
9972@code{false}.
9973@end deftypefn
9974
9975@hook TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE
9976This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
9977which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
9978table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
9979Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
9980the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
9981some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
9982method. The default is to return @code{true}.
9983@end deftypefn
9984
9985@hook TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY
9986
9987@hook TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT
9988This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
9989similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
9990external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
9991classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
9992unit will not be COMDAT.
9993@end deftypefn
9994
9995@hook TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT
9996This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
9997the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
9998be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
9999@end deftypefn
10000
10001@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT
10002This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10003should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10004is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10005@end deftypefn
10006
10007@hook TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT
10008This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10009in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10010destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10011shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10012unloaded. The default is to return false.
10013@end deftypefn
10014
10015@hook TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION
10016
17c4f786
AS
10017@hook TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT
10018
38f8b050
JR
10019@node Named Address Spaces
10020@section Adding support for named address spaces
10021@cindex named address spaces
10022
10023The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10024standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10025support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10026processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10027GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10028address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10029spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10030@code{const} type attributes.
10031
10032Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10033pointers to the generic address space.
10034
10035For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10036to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10037processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10038issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10039local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10040address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10041@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10042always 32 bits).
10043
10044Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10045range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10046address space.
10047
10048To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10049the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10050the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10051named address space #1:
10052@smallexample
10053#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10054c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10055@end smallexample
10056
10057@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE
10058Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10059@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10060The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode} for the
10061generic address space only.
10062@end deftypefn
10063
10064@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE
10065Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10066@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10067The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode} for the
10068generic address space only.
10069@end deftypefn
10070
10071@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE
10072Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10073with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10074hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10075except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10076version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10077@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10078target hooks for the given address space.
10079@end deftypefn
10080
10081@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P
10082Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10083@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10084parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10085finished. This target hook is the same as the
10086@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10087explicit named address space support.
10088@end deftypefn
10089
10090@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS
10091Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10092with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10093hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10094except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10095@end deftypefn
10096
10097@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P
10098Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10099contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10100a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10101will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10102arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10103converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10104@end deftypefn
10105
10106@hook TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT
10107Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10108@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10109space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10110to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10111guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10112as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10113@end deftypefn
10114
10115@node Misc
10116@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10117@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10118
10119@c prevent bad page break with this line
10120Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10121
10122@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10123Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10124has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10125conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10126blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10127set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10128to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10129@end defmac
10130
10131@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10132Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10133has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10134conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10135blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10136set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10137to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10138@end defmac
10139
10140@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10141An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10142elements of a jump-table should have.
10143@end defmac
10144
10145@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10146Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10147when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10148it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10149To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10150make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10151The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10152flags can be updated.
10153@end defmac
10154
10155@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10156Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10157should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10158jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10159contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10160is in effect.
10161@end defmac
10162
10163@hook TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
10164This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10165is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10166The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10167five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10168@end deftypefn
10169
38f8b050
JR
10170@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10171Define this macro if operations between registers with integral mode
10172smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10173Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10174@end defmac
10175
10176@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10177Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10178memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10179bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10180zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10181of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10182insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10183@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10184
10185This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10186greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10187value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10188@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10189define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10190
10191You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10192the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10193of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10194when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10195integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10196
10197You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10198mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10199@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10200is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10201@end defmac
10202
10203@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10204Define this macro if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10205extends.
10206@end defmac
10207
38f8b050
JR
10208@hook TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL
10209When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10210divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10211the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10212that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10213of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10214has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10215@end deftypefn
10216
10217@defmac MOVE_MAX
10218The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10219between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10220@end defmac
10221
10222@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10223The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10224between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10225is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10226constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10227at run-time.
10228@end defmac
10229
10230@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10231A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10232actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10233of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10234this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10235a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10236truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10237instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10238include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10239also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10240arguments to bit-field instructions.
10241
10242If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10243position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10244instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10245
10246However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10247only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10248bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10249such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10250the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10251
10252You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10253@end defmac
10254
10255@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10256@hook TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK
10257This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10258deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10259@xref{shift patterns}.
10260
10261On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10262shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10263equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10264this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10265otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10266particular behavior is guaranteed.
10267
10268Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10269@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10270that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10271
10272The default implementation of this function returns
10273@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10274and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10275@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10276nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10277by overriding it.
10278@end deftypefn
10279
10280@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10281A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10282``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10283bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10284operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10285
10286On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10287
10288@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10289@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10290When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10291modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10292If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10293such cases may improve things.
10294@end defmac
10295
10296@hook TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED
10297The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10298are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10299@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10300sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10301otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10302representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10303@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10304@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10305@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10306widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10307
10308Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10309value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10310as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10311@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10312
10313Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10314describe two related properties. If you define
10315@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10316to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10317extension.
10318
10319In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10320@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10321@code{mode}.
10322@end deftypefn
10323
10324@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10325A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10326with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10327(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10328apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10329comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10330
10331A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10332comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10333and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10334which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10335true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10336operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10337@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10338@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10339the compiler.
10340
10341If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10342generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10343replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10344the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10345For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10346@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10347@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10348expression
10349
10350@smallexample
10351(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10352@end smallexample
10353
10354@noindent
10355can be converted to
10356
10357@smallexample
10358(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10359@end smallexample
10360
10361@noindent
10362where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10363tested into the sign bit.
10364
10365There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10366for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10367but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10368are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10369perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10370comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10371
10372Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10373from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10374choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10375to be used:
10376
10377@itemize @bullet
10378@item
10379Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10380@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10381``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10382comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10383combine the normalization with other operations.
10384
10385@item
10386For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10387slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10388other machines.
10389
10390@item
10391As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10392exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10393others.
10394
10395@item
10396Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10397@end itemize
10398
10399Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10400@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10401instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10402those cases, e.g., one matching
10403
10404@smallexample
10405(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10406@end smallexample
10407
10408Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10409condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10410@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10411machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10412and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10413@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
2b0d3573 10414@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
38f8b050
JR
10415find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10416
10417If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10418not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10419instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10420@end defmac
10421
10422@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10423A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10424returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10425Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10426floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10427this macro.
10428@end defmac
10429
10430@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10431A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10432for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10433mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10434this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10435return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10436this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10437@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10438the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10439given mode.
10440@end defmac
10441
10442@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10443@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10444A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
ff2ce160 10445for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
38f8b050
JR
10446A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10447If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10448evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10449entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
ff2ce160 10450the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
38f8b050 10451In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
ff2ce160 10452this value.
38f8b050
JR
10453
10454If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10455@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10456
10457This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10458relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10459is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10460to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10461
10462Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10463and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10464visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10465to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10466breaking the API@.
10467@end defmac
10468
10469@defmac Pmode
10470An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10471this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10472pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10473On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10474modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10475
10476The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10477@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10478@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10479to @code{Pmode}.
10480@end defmac
10481
10482@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10483An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10484being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
ff2ce160 10485where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
38f8b050
JR
10486@code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10487size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10488as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10489@end defmac
10490
10491@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10492In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10493constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10494hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10495where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10496strict conformance to the C Standard.
10497
10498Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10499convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10500files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10501@end defmac
10502
10503@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10504Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10505This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10506C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10507@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10508@end defmac
10509
10510@findex #pragma
10511@findex pragma
10512@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10513Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10514If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10515@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10516for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10517setup required for the pragmas.
10518
10519The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10520other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10521definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10522
10523If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10524defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10525
10526Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10527@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10528silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10529@end defmac
10530
10531@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10532@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10533
10534Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10535@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10536@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10537pragma of the form
10538
10539@smallexample
10540#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10541@end smallexample
10542
10543@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10544@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10545routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10546on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10547@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10548callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10549a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10550arguments of pragmas registered with
10551@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10552pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10553
10554Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10555compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10556other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10557to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10558building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10559variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10560target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10561the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10562code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10563rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10564how to build this object file.
10565@end deftypefun
10566
38f8b050 10567@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
24a57808 10568Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
38f8b050
JR
10569arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10570@end defmac
10571
38f8b050
JR
10572@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10573If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10574the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10575This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10576@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10577@end defmac
10578
10579@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10580Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10581identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10582not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10583there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10584@end defmac
10585
10586@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
10587Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10588@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
10589G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
10590@samp{.} is used instead.
10591@end defmac
10592
10593@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
10594Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
10595@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
10596have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
10597are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
10598@end defmac
10599
10600@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10601Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10602delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10603even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10604@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10605every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10606or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10607you should define this macro.
10608
10609You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10610@end defmac
10611
10612@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10613Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10614delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10615even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10616@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10617some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10618are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10619define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10620instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10621slot of @var{insn}.
10622
10623You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10624@end defmac
10625
10626@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10627Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10628global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10629symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10630instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10631from shared libraries (DLLs).
10632
10633You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10634@end defmac
10635
10636@hook TARGET_MD_ASM_CLOBBERS
10637This target hook should add to @var{clobbers} @code{STRING_CST} trees for
10638any hard regs the port wishes to automatically clobber for an asm.
10639It should return the result of the last @code{tree_cons} used to add a
10640clobber. The @var{outputs}, @var{inputs} and @var{clobber} lists are the
10641corresponding parameters to the asm and may be inspected to avoid
10642clobbering a register that is an input or output of the asm. You can use
10643@code{tree_overlaps_hard_reg_set}, declared in @file{tree.h}, to test
10644for overlap with regards to asm-declared registers.
10645@end deftypefn
10646
10647@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10648Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
d9d16a19
JM
10649in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10650@samp{""} if the target does not have a
38f8b050
JR
10651separate math library.
10652
d9d16a19 10653You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
38f8b050
JR
10654@end defmac
10655
10656@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10657Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10658specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10659
10660You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10661is wrong.
10662@end defmac
10663
10664@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10665Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10666functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10667Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10668to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10669if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10670for cross-profiling.
10671@end defmac
10672
10673@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10674
10675A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10676conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10677@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
106781 if it does use cc0.
10679@end defmac
10680
10681@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10682Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10683conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10684@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10685contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10686and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10687then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10688@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10689@end defmac
10690
10691@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10692Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10693if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10694@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10695being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10696@end defmac
10697
10698@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10699A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10700be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10701a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10702about the currently processed blocks.
10703@end defmac
10704
10705@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10706A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10707converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10708can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10709to by @var{ce_info}.
10710@end defmac
10711
10712@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10713A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10714converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10715can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10716to by @var{ce_info}.
10717@end defmac
10718
67a0732f
SB
10719@defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
10720A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
10721of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10722to by @var{ce_info}.
38f8b050
JR
10723@end defmac
10724
10725@hook TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG
10726If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
10727instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
10728just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
10729
10730The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
10731it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
10732laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
10733Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
10734
10735You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
10736definition is null.
10737@end deftypefn
10738
10739@hook TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS
10740Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10741that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
10742necessary setup.
10743
10744Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
10745instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
10746they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
10747instructions or prefetch instructions).
10748
10749To create a built-in function, call the function
10750@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
10751which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
1a072294 10752up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
38f8b050
JR
10753only language front ends that use those two functions will call
10754@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
10755@end deftypefn
10756
10757@hook TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL
10758Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
10759that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
10760builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
10761If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
10762if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
10763If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
10764@code{error_mark_node}.
10765@end deftypefn
10766
10767@hook TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN
10768
10769Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10770@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
10771function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
10772convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
10773@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
10774@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
10775ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
10776built-in function.
10777@end deftypefn
10778
d66f5459 10779@hook TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10780Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
10781was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
10782@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
10783implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
10784declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
10785arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
10786complete expression that implements the operation, usually
10787another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
10788@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
10789@end deftypefn
10790
08914aaa 10791@hook TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN
38f8b050
JR
10792Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
10793@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
10794built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
10795the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
10796The result is another tree containing a simplified expression for the
10797call's result. If @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
10798@end deftypefn
10799
10800@hook TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP
10801
10802Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
10803low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
10804could not be applied.
10805
10806Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
10807instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
10808the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
10809By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
10810loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
10811@end deftypefn
10812
10813@defmac MD_CAN_REDIRECT_BRANCH (@var{branch1}, @var{branch2})
10814
10815Take a branch insn in @var{branch1} and another in @var{branch2}.
10816Return true if redirecting @var{branch1} to the destination of
10817@var{branch2} is possible.
10818
10819On some targets, branches may have a limited range. Optimizing the
10820filling of delay slots can result in branches being redirected, and this
10821may in turn cause a branch offset to overflow.
10822@end defmac
10823
10824@hook TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P
10825This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
10826Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
10827PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
10828of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
10829@end deftypefn
10830
10831@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE
10832
10833When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
10834register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
10835to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
10836it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
10837is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
10838that had its initial value copied by using
10839@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
10840Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
10841to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
10842the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
10843@code{MEM}.
10844If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
10845it might decide to use another register anyways.
10846You may use @code{current_function_leaf_function} in the hook, functions
10847that use @code{REG_N_SETS}, to determine if the hard
10848register in question will not be clobbered.
10849The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
10850allocation.
10851@end deftypefn
10852
10853@hook TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P
10854This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
10855@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
10856this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
10857@code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
10858to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
10859passed along.
10860@end deftypefn
10861
10862@hook TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION
ff2ce160 10863The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
38f8b050
JR
10864context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
10865the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
10866per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
10867attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
10868The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
10869and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
10870and is returning to processing at the top level.
10871The default hook function does nothing.
10872
10873GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
10874some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
10875situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
10876or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
10877@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
10878outside of any function scope.
10879@end deftypefn
10880
10881@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
10882Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
10883files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
10884use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
10885@end defmac
10886
10887@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
10888Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
10889automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
10890do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
10891executable files.
10892@end defmac
10893
10894@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
10895If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
10896specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
10897Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
10898object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
10899lists.
10900@end defmac
10901
10902@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
10903Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
10904method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
10905must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
10906For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
10907the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
10908defined as this expression:
10909
10910@smallexample
10911build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
10912 build_tree_list
10913 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
10914 NULL))
10915@end smallexample
10916@end defmac
10917
10918@hook TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P
10919This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
10920instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
10921every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
10922reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
10923
10924@smallexample
10925static bool
10926cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
10927@{
10928 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
10929@}
10930@end smallexample
10931@end deftypefn
10932
10933@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS
10934This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
10935optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
10936usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
10937re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
10938to inter-block scheduling.
10939@end deftypefn
10940
10941@hook TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED
10942Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
10943registers
10944that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
10945returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
10946that all target registers in the class returned by
10947@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
10948saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
10949epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
10950true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
10951to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
10952to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
10953@end deftypefn
10954
10955@hook TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION
10956This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
10957This target hook is required only when the target has several different
10958modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
10959@end deftypefn
10960
10961@hook TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST
10962This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
10963should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
10964the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
10965the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
10966is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
10967number of memory accesses.
10968@end deftypefn
10969
10970@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
10971If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
10972that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
10973that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
10974constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
10975more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
10976system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
10977The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
10978@end defmac
10979
10980@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
10981This target hook should register any extra include files for the
10982target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
10983are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
10984The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
10985@end deftypefn
10986
10987@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
10988This target hook should register any extra include files for the
10989target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
10990indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
10991@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
10992@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
10993@end deftypefn
10994
10995@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
10996This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
10997The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
10998systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
10999that are different from @option{-I}.
11000@end deftypefn
11001
11002@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11003This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11004for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11005@code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11006functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11007@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11008@end defmac
11009
11010@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11011If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11012target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11013option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11014@end defmac
11015
11016@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11017If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11018@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11019@end defmac
11020
11021@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11022If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11023target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11024default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11025@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11026@end defmac
11027
11028@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11029If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11030@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11031@end defmac
11032
11033@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11034If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11035routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11036and scanf formatter settings.
11037@end defmac
11038
11039@hook TARGET_RELAXED_ORDERING
11040If set to @code{true}, means that the target's memory model does not
11041guarantee that loads which do not depend on one another will access
11042main memory in the order of the instruction stream; if ordering is
11043important, an explicit memory barrier must be used. This is true of
11044many recent processors which implement a policy of ``relaxed,''
11045``weak,'' or ``release'' memory consistency, such as Alpha, PowerPC,
11046and ia64. The default is @code{false}.
11047@end deftypevr
11048
11049@hook TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN
11050If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11051illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11052with prototype @var{typelist}.
11053@end deftypefn
11054
11055@hook TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION
11056If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11057invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11058if validity should be determined by the front end.
11059@end deftypefn
11060
11061@hook TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP
11062If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11063invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11064@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11065if validity should be determined by the front end.
11066@end deftypefn
11067
11068@hook TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP
11069If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11070invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11071and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11072the front end.
11073@end deftypefn
11074
11075@hook TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE
11076If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
ff2ce160 11077invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
38f8b050
JR
11078or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11079the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11080@end deftypefn
11081
11082@hook TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE
11083If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
ff2ce160 11084invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
38f8b050
JR
11085or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11086the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11087@end deftypefn
11088
11089@hook TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE
ff2ce160
MS
11090If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11091@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
38f8b050
JR
11092analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11093front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11094target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11095This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11096@end deftypefn
11097
11098@hook TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE
ff2ce160
MS
11099If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11100@var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
38f8b050 11101or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
ff2ce160 11102This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
38f8b050
JR
11103conversion rules.
11104This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11105@end deftypefn
11106
11107@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11108This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11109classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11110SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11111@end defmac
11112
11113@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11114This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11115NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11116@end defmac
11117
11118@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11119Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
ff2ce160 11120to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
38f8b050
JR
11121call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11122and the associated definitions of those functions.
11123@end defmac
11124
11125@hook TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY
11126Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11127necessary.
11128@end deftypefn
11129
11130@hook TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX
11131This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11132different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11133argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11134is needed.
11135@end deftypefn
11136
11137@hook TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS
11138When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11139arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11140stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11141debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11142@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11143cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11144to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11145false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11146@end deftypefn
11147
11148@hook TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11149On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11150a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11151is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11152is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11153subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11154the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11155available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11156constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11157down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11158@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11159accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11160value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11161MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11162@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11163is zero, which disables this optimization. @end deftypevr
57c5ab1b 11164
5dcfdccd
KY
11165@hook TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK
11166Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11167memory model bits are allowed.
11168@end deftypefn
11169
57c5ab1b 11170@hook TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL